Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
Apple® iOS
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Android™
Please note that the Mercedes-Benz Guides
App may not yet be available in your country.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all of
the documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
You can also use the Mercedes-Benz Guides
App:
1175841002Z102 É1175841002Z102TËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 29
Introduction ......................................... 22
Safety ................................................... 41
Opening and closing ........................... 85
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .. 111
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 125
Climate control ................................. 143
Driving and parking .......................... 163
On-board computer and displays .... 245
Stowing and features ....................... 315
Maintenance and care ...................... 333
Breakdown assistance ..................... 349
Wheels and tyres .............................. 369
Technical data ................................... 399
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4MATIC
Display message ............................ 297
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 215
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 266
Function/notes ................................ 73
Important safety notes .................... 73
Warning lamp ................................. 304
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 59
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 154
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 149
Active light function ......................... 130
Active Parking Assist
Detecting parking spaces .............. 221
Display message ............................ 288
Exiting a parking space .................. 224
Function/notes ............................. 220
Important safety notes .................. 220
Parking .......................................... 222
Towing a trailer .............................. 220
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 80
Adaptive Brake Assist
Function/notes ................................ 75
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 76
Adaptive Damping System
Function/notes ............................. 215
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 283
Function/notes ............................. 131
Switching on/off ........................... 132
Additional speedometer ................... 258
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 408
Adjusting the headlamp range ......... 128
Air conditioning
General notes ................................ 144
Air filter (white display message) .... 286
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Important safety notes .................. 161
Rear ............................................... 162
Setting the centre air vents ........... 162
Setting the side air vents ............... 162
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 51
Introduction ..................................... 48
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps ............................................... 43
Airbags
Display message ............................ 278
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 49
Important safety guidelines ............. 48
Kneebag ........................................... 50
Sidebag ............................................ 50
Triggering ......................................... 57
Windowbag ...................................... 51
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 81
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 81
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 81
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
AMG
Performance Seat .......................... 117
RIDE CONTROL sports suspension ................................................ 215
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 262
AMG Performance exhaust system ..................................................... 172
Anti-glare film .................................... 331
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 198
Index
Ashtray ............................................... 327
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 255
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 255
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 340
Driving abroad ............................... 340
Hiding a service message .............. 340
Information about Service ............. 340
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 340
Service message ............................ 339
Special service requirements ......... 340
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 81
Function ........................................... 81
Switching off the alarm .................... 81
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 257
Display message ............................ 286
Function/notes ............................. 230
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 253
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 282
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 171
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 170
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation
Display message ............................ 278
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 52
Problems ......................................... 56
System self-test ............................... 54
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 127
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position ............. 182
Changing gear ............................... 182
DIRECT SELECT lever ..................... 177
Drive program display .................... 178
Drive programs .............................. 183
Driving tips ....................................
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ...............................................
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
Emergency running mode ..............
Engaging drive position ..................
Engaging neutral ............................
Engaging park position
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..............
Engaging park position automatically ...............................................
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Engaging the park position ............
Holding the vehicle stationary on
uphill gradients ..............................
Kickdown .......................................
Manual shifting ..............................
Oil temperature (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .....
Overview ........................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Trailer towing .................................
Transmission position display ........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Remote control ..............................
Setting ...........................................
Auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Setting the departure time .............
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating .................
182
174
175
188
180
179
181
179
179
178
182
182
185
262
177
188
168
180
168
185
183
180
178
181
188
157
157
157
260
298
156
161
159
157
5
6
Index
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) .............................. 157
Remote control .............................. 157
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ...................................................... 412
B
Bag hook ............................................ 321
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 241
Folding out ..................................... 240
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 73
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 90
Important safety notes .................... 89
Replacing ......................................... 90
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 359
Display message ............................ 284
Important safety notes .................. 356
Jump starting ................................. 360
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 57
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 257
Display message ............................ 288
Notes/function .............................. 234
Trailer towing ................................. 236
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 334
Closing ........................................... 336
Display message ............................ 297
Important safety notes .................. 334
Opening ......................................... 335
Boot lid
see Tailgate
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 410
Brake
EBD .................................................. 80
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 273
Notes ............................................. 408
Brake force distribution
see EBD (electronic brake force
distribution)
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 76
Changing bulbs .............................. 137
Display message ............................ 280
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 73
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 75
BAS .................................................. 73
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 408
Display message ............................ 266
Driving tips .................................... 197
Hill start assist ............................... 169
HOLD function ............................... 211
Important safety notes .................. 197
Parking brake ................................ 193
Warning lamp ................................. 303
Breakdown
Where will I find...? ........................ 350
see Flat tyre
see Tow-starting
see Towing away
Brightness control (instrument
cluster lighting) ................................... 32
Buttons on the steering column ...... 247
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Car
see Vehicle
Car wash (care) .................................
Care
Automatic car wash .......................
Carpets ..........................................
Display ...........................................
Exhaust pipe ..................................
Exterior lighting .............................
Gear or selector lever ....................
High-pressure cleaner ....................
Interior ...........................................
Matt paintwork ..............................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
341
341
347
346
345
344
346
342
346
342
340
342
Index
Plastic trim .................................... 346
Reversing camera .......................... 344
Roof lining ...................................... 347
Seat belt ........................................ 347
Seat cover ..................................... 346
Sensors ......................................... 344
Steering wheel ............................... 346
Trim pieces .................................... 346
Washing by hand ........................... 341
Wheels ........................................... 343
Windows ........................................ 343
Wiper blades .................................. 344
Wooden trim .................................. 346
CD player (on-board computer) ........ 253
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 260
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 87
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 37
Upper section .................................. 36
Changing bulbs
Brake lamps ................................... 137
Cornering light function ................. 136
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 135
Main-beam headlamps ................... 136
Rear foglamp ................................. 137
Turn signals (front) ......................... 136
Turn signals (rear) .......................... 137
Child
Restraint system .............................. 60
Child seat
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 65
ISOFIX .............................................. 61
On the front-passenger seat ............ 63
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 64
Recommendations ........................... 69
Suitable positions ............................ 65
Top Tether ....................................... 62
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 71
Rear doors ....................................... 71
Cigarette lighter ................................ 328
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 344
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 345
Climate control
Air conditioning ............................. 145
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 156
Controlling automatically ............... 150
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 154
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 149
Demisting the windows .................. 152
Demisting the windscreen ............. 152
Indicator lamp ................................ 150
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 147
Notes on using the air-conditioning system ..................................... 145
Overview of systems ...................... 144
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 154
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 150
Setting the air distribution ............. 151
Setting the air vents ...................... 161
Setting the airflow ......................... 151
Setting the temperature ................ 150
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 154
Switching on/off ........................... 148
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 155
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 153
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 151
THERMOTRONIC (2-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 147
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 30
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS
Activating/deactivating ................. 256
Display message ............................ 273
Operation/notes .............................. 73
COMAND display
Cleaning ......................................... 346
Combination switch .......................... 129
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 250
Convenience closing feature ............ 103
Convenience opening feature .......... 102
7
8
Index
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ...........................
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level .........................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ...............
Temperature gauge ........................
Warning lamp .................................
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright .............................................
Cornering lamps
Changing bulbs ..............................
Cornering light function
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Crash-responsive emergency lighting .......................................................
Cruise control
Activation conditions .....................
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message ............................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear compartment .........................
154
338
283
408
262
247
310
27
136
279
130
133
200
200
201
290
199
199
200
200
201
200
326
325
326
D
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 282
Function/notes ............................. 127
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declarations of conformity ................. 24
Diagnostics connection ...................... 24
Diesel .................................................. 405
Digital speedometer ......................... 251
Dipped-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 135
Display message ............................ 279
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 126
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 259
Switching on/off ........................... 127
DIRECT SELECT lever
Automatic transmission ................. 177
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 286
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 339
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 265
Engine ............................................ 283
General information ....................... 265
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 265
Key ................................................ 300
Lights ............................................. 279
Safety systems .............................. 266
Tyres .............................................. 292
Vehicle ........................................... 294
Distance warning function
Function/notes ................................ 74
Warning lamp ................................. 312
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 312
DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions ..................... 206
Cruise control lever ....................... 205
Deactivating ................................... 209
Display message ............................ 289
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 209
Driving tips .................................... 210
Function/notes ............................. 204
Important safety notes .................. 204
Selecting ........................................ 205
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 208
Stopping ........................................ 207
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 260
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 95
Index
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 87
Control panel ................................... 39
Display message ............................ 298
Emergency locking ........................... 96
Emergency unlocking ....................... 95
Important safety notes .................... 93
Opening (from the inside) ................ 93
Drive program
Display ........................................... 180
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 178
Manual transmission ...................... 177
Drive programs
Automatic transmission ................. 183
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 340
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 126
Driving on flooded roads .................. 198
Driving safety system
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS ................................................ 73
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 80
STEER CONTROL ............................. 80
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 73
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 80
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 75
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 76
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 73
Distance warning function ............... 74
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 76
Important safety guidelines ............. 72
Overview .......................................... 72
Driving system
Start-off assist ............................... 213
Driving systems
Active Parking Assist ..................... 220
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 215
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 230
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 234
Cruise control ................................ 199
Display message ............................ 286
Distronic Plus ................................ 204
HOLD function ............................... 211
Lane Keeping Assist ......................
Lane package ................................
PARKTRONIC .................................
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ..........
Reversing camera ..........................
SPEEDTRONIC ...............................
Traffic Sign Assist ..........................
Driving tips
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
DISTRONIC PLUS ...........................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
Fuel ................................................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
The first 1500 km ..........................
Towing a trailer ..............................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....................................................
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .................
DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Climate control (air conditioning) ..
Climate control
(THERMOTRONIC) ..........................
236
234
216
214
225
202
231
198
182
197
210
197
126
198
198
198
196
195
198
197
198
164
373
126
164
239
197
253
174
175
146
148
E
EASY-PACK tailgate
see Tailgate
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 268
9
10
Index
Function/notes ................................ 80
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 196
On-board computer ....................... 250
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 171
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 170
Deactivating/activating ................. 171
General information ....................... 170
Important safety notes .................. 170
Introduction ................................... 170
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 24
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 59
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 95
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 89
Inserting .......................................... 89
Locking vehicle ................................ 96
Removing ......................................... 89
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 95
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 396
Important safety notes .................. 396
Removing ....................................... 397
Technical data ............................... 398
Emergency unlocking
Tailgate .......................................... 100
Vehicle ............................................. 95
Engine
Display message ............................ 283
ECO start/stop function ................ 170
Engine number ............................... 402
Jump-starting ................................. 360
Running irregularly ......................... 173
Starting (important safety notes) ... 167
Starting problems .......................... 173
Starting the engine with the key .... 168
Starting with the Start/Stop button ................................................. 168
Stopping ........................................ 192
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 366
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 310
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 400
Problem (fault) ............................... 173
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 408
Checking the oil level ..................... 336
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 336
Display message ............................ 285
Filling capacity ............................... 407
Notes about oil grades ................... 406
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 336
Temperature (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 262
Topping up ..................................... 337
Viscosity ........................................ 408
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 22
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 262
Characteristics ................................. 77
Deactivating/activating (button
in Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............. 78
Deactivating/activating (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles) ................. 77
Deactivating/activating (onboard computer, except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 256
Display message ............................ 266
Function/notes ................................ 76
General notes .................................. 76
Important safety guidelines ............. 77
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 79
Warning lamp ................................. 306
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 77
Exhaust
see Exhaust pipe
Exhaust pipe
Cleaning ......................................... 345
Exterior lighting
Cleaning ......................................... 344
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 119
Index
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ......................................
Folding in/out (automatically) .......
Folding in/out (electrically) ...........
Out of position (troubleshooting) ...
Parking position .............................
Resetting .......................................
Storing settings (memory function) ...............................................
120
261
120
120
120
121
120
122
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ...............................
First-aid kit .........................................
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ...............................
Lowering the vehicle ......................
Preparing the vehicle .....................
Raising the vehicle .........................
Removing a wheel ..........................
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the
spare wheel ...................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Preparing the vehicle .....................
TIREFIT kit ......................................
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat .............................................
Foglamps
Switching on/off ...........................
Foglamps (extended range) ..............
Frequencies
Mobile phone .................................
Two-way radio ................................
Front foglamps
Display message ............................
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Display message ............................
351
350
383
383
380
381
383
381
379
352
352
353
331
127
131
400
400
281
278
Front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Operation ......................................... 52
Problems ......................................... 56
System self-test ............................... 54
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 405
Consumption information .............. 406
Consumption statistics .................. 250
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 250
Displaying the range ...................... 250
Driving tips .................................... 196
E10 ................................................ 404
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Grade (petrol) ................................ 404
Important safety notes .................. 403
Low outside temperatures ............. 406
Notes for CLA 250 ......................... 405
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 404
Problem (malfunction) ................... 191
Quality (diesel) ............................... 405
Refuelling ....................................... 188
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 403
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 189
Fuel filter (white display message) .. 286
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 250
Gauge .............................................. 32
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 403
Problem (malfunction) ................... 191
Fuses
Allocation chart ............................. 368
Before changing ............................. 367
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 367
Fuse box in the front-passenger
footwell .......................................... 368
Important safety notes .................. 367
11
12
Index
G
Gear indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 262
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 262
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 22
Glove compartment .......................... 317
H
Hazard warning lamps
Display message ............................ 300
Switching on/off ........................... 129
Head restraints
Adjusting ....................................... 115
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 115
Adjusting (rear) .............................. 116
Fitting/removing (rear) .................. 116
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............ 129
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 409
Headlamp flasher .............................. 129
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 132
Topping up the cleaning system .... 339
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 342
Hill start assist .................................. 169
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 212
Deactivating ................................... 212
Display message ............................ 287
Function/notes ............................. 211
Horn ...................................................... 30
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 80
Indicator and warning lamp
Restraint system ............................ 309
Indicator and warning lamps
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS .............................................. 312
Coolant .......................................... 310
Engine diagnostics ......................... 310
SPORT handling mode ................... 307
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 280
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 32
Settings ......................................... 258
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 33
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 246
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 259
Display message ............................ 282
Overview ........................................ 130
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 259
Interior lighting
Control ........................................... 133
Emergency lighting ........................ 133
Overview ........................................ 132
Reading lamp ................................. 132
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 83
Function ........................................... 82
Priming ............................................ 82
Switching off .................................... 83
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 61
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 351
Using ............................................. 381
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 360
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 90
Checking the battery ....................... 90
Convenience closing feature .......... 103
Convenience opening feature ........ 102
Display message ............................ 300
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 87
Emergency key element ................... 89
Important safety notes .................... 86
Index
KEYLESS-GO start function .............. 88
Loss ................................................. 91
Modifying the programming ............. 88
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 165
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 91
Starting the engine ........................ 168
Key positions
Start/Stop button .......................... 165
Key positions (ignition lock) ............ 165
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ...................... 103
Deactivation ..................................... 87
Locking ............................................ 87
Unlocking ......................................... 87
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 182
Manual gearshifting ....................... 187
Kneebag ............................................... 50
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................
Display message ............................
Function/information ....................
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Active light function .......................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist .............
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps .......................................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
257
287
236
234
263
321
281
282
259
130
131
127
130
127
126
127
131
129
Headlamp flasher ........................... 129
Headlamp range ............................ 128
Light switch ................................... 126
Main-beam headlamps ................... 129
Misted up headlamps .................... 132
Motorway mode ............................. 130
Parking lamps ................................ 128
Rear foglamp ................................. 128
Setting exterior lighting ................. 126
Side lamps ..................................... 128
Turn signals ................................... 129
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 200
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 205
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 202
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 316
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 95
Emergency locking ........................... 96
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 94
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 260
Luggage compartment cover
Fitting/removing ........................... 322
Important safety notes .................. 321
Notes/function .............................. 321
Luggage compartment enlargement ................................................... 319
Luggage compartment floor
Important safety notes .................. 324
opening/closing ............................ 324
stowage well, under ....................... 324
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 116
M
M+S tyres ........................................... 372
Main-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ............. 131
13
14
Index
Changing bulbs .............................. 136
Display message ............................ 281
Switching on/off ........................... 129
Manual transmission
Drive program ................................ 177
DYNAMIC SELECT button .............. 174
Engaging reverse gear ................... 176
Gear lever ...................................... 176
Pulling away ................................... 168
Shift recommendation ................... 176
Shifting to neutral .......................... 176
Starting the engine ........................ 167
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) .. 342
Memory card (audio) ......................... 253
Memory function ............................... 122
Mercedes-Benz emergency call
system
Switch in the overhead control
panel .............................................. 329
Mercedes-Benz Intelligent Drive
Traffic Sign Assist .......................... 231
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 265
Messages
see Display messages
Mirror turn signal
Cleaning ......................................... 344
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone
Frequencies ................................... 400
Installation ..................................... 400
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 254
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 329
Transmission output (maximum) .... 400
Mobile telephone
Pre-installed bracket ...................... 331
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 88
MOExtended tyres ............................. 352
Motorway mode ................................ 130
MP3
Operating ....................................... 253
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 249
Permanent display ......................... 258
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 247
Overview .......................................... 34
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 251
Notes on running in a new vehicle .. 164
O
Occupant safety
Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation .......................... 51
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 59
Children in the vehicle ..................... 59
Important safety notes .................... 43
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator
lamp ................................................. 43
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 72
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 58
Restraint system introduction .......... 42
Restraint system warning lamp ........ 43
Seat belts ........................................ 44
Odometer ........................................... 250
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 262
Assistance graphic menu ............... 255
Assistance menu ........................... 255
Audio menu ................................... 253
Convenience submenu .................. 261
Display messages .......................... 265
Displaying a service message ........ 340
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 209
Factory settings ............................. 262
Heating submenu ........................... 260
Important safety notes .................. 246
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 258
Light submenu ............................... 259
Menu overview .............................. 249
Message memory .......................... 265
Navigation menu ............................ 251
Index
Operating video DVD ..................... 253
Operation ....................................... 247
RACETIMER ................................... 263
Service menu ................................. 257
Settings menu ............................... 258
Standard display ............................ 250
Telephone menu ............................ 254
Trip menu ...................................... 250
Vehicle submenu ........................... 259
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 136
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 23
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 24
Important safety note ...................... 23
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 247
Overhead control panel ...................... 40
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 72
P
Paint code .......................................... 402
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 342
Panic alarm .......................................... 42
Panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety information ......... 105
Operating ....................................... 106
Operating the roller sunblinds for
the sliding sunroof ......................... 107
Problem (malfunction) ................... 110
Rain-closing feature (when driving) ................................................ 107
Rain-closing feature (when the
engine is switched off) ................... 107
Reversing feature ........................... 106
Parking
Important safety notes .................. 192
Parking brake ................................ 193
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 121
Reversing camera .......................... 225
see Active Parking Assist
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 220
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 269
Electric parking brake .................... 193
Warning lamp ................................. 309
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 281
Switching on/off ........................... 128
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 219
Driving system ............................... 216
Function/notes ............................. 216
Important safety notes .................. 216
Problem (fault) ............................... 220
Sensor range ................................. 217
Warning display ............................. 218
PASSENGER AIR BAG
Display message ............................ 278
Indicator lamps ................................ 43
Problems (malfunctions) ................ 278
Petrol .................................................. 404
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 72
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 346
Power windows
see Side windows
Pre-Crash Safety System
see PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory
occupant protection)
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 58
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 274
Protection against theft
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 81
Immobiliser ...................................... 80
Interior motion sensor ..................... 82
Tow-away protection ........................ 81
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 22
15
16
Index
Pulling away
Automatic transmission .................
General notes ................................
Hill start assist ...............................
Manual transmission ......................
Trailer ............................................
168
168
169
168
169
Q
QR code
Mercedes-Benz Guide App ................. 1
Rescue card ..................................... 26
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 25
R
RACE START
important safety notes ................... 214
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ............. 214
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 263
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 253
see separate operating instructions
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 24
Rain closing feature (panorama
sliding sunroof) ................................. 107
Reading lamp ..................................... 132
Rear bench seat
Folding the backrest forwards/
back ............................................... 320
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 162
Rear foglamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 137
Display message ............................ 281
Switching on/off ........................... 128
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear seat
Adjusting the angle of the backrests ................................................ 320
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 154
Switching on/off ........................... 153
Rear window wiper
Replacing the wiper blade .............. 140
Switching on/off ........................... 138
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 48
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 120
Dipping (manual) ........................... 119
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Important safety notes .................. 188
Notes for Mercedes‑AMG vehicles ................................................ 404
Refuelling process ......................... 189
see Fuel
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 157
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 159
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes .................. 133
Overview of bulb types .................. 134
Removing/replacing the cover
(front wheel arch) .......................... 135
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 159
Rescue card ......................................... 26
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 286
Warning lamp ................................. 310
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 155
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 275
Introduction ..................................... 42
Warning lamp ................................. 309
Warning lamp (function) ................... 43
Rev counter ........................................ 247
Reverse gear
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 176
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 180
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 344
Displays in the Audio display ......... 226
Displays in the COMAND display ... 226
Function/notes ............................. 225
Switching on/off ........................... 226
Reversing feature
Panorama sliding sunroof .............. 106
Index
Side windows ................................. 101
Tailgate ............................................ 97
Reversing function
Roller sunblind ............................... 108
Reversing lamps
Display message ............................ 281
Roller sunblind
Panorama sliding sunroof .............. 107
Roof carrier ........................................ 324
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 347
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 410
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 59
Safety net
Attaching ....................................... 323
Important safety information ......... 323
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Seat
Adjusting (Performance Seat) ........ 117
Folding the backrest (rear compartment) forwards/back .............. 320
Seat belt
Correct usage .................................. 46
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 261
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 47
Adjusting the height ......................... 46
Cleaning ......................................... 347
Display message ............................ 274
Fastening ......................................... 46
Important safety guidelines ............. 44
Introduction ..................................... 44
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 48
Releasing ......................................... 47
Warning lamp ................................. 301
Warning lamp (function) ................... 47
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 115
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 114
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 116
Adjusting the head restraint ..........
Cleaning the cover .........................
Correct driver's seat position ........
Important safety notes ..................
Seat heating problem ....................
Storing settings (memory function) ...............................................
Switching seat heating on/off .......
Selector lever
Cleaning .........................................
Sensors (cleaning instructions) .......
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) ..................................................
Service message
see ASSYST PLUS
Service products
Brake fluid .....................................
Coolant (engine) ............................
Engine oil .......................................
Fuel ................................................
Important safety notes ..................
Washer fluid ...................................
Setting the air distribution ...............
Setting the airflow ............................
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) .........
On-board computer .......................
SETUP (on-board computer) .............
Shifting to neutral (manual transmission) .............................................
Side lamps
Switching on/off ...........................
Side windows
Convenience closing ......................
Convenience opening ....................
Important safety notes ..................
Opening/closing ............................
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Resetting .......................................
Reversing feature ...........................
Sidebag ................................................
Sliding sunroof
see Panorama sliding sunroof
115
346
112
113
118
122
117
346
344
257
408
408
406
402
402
409
151
151
262
258
262
176
128
103
102
101
102
105
104
101
50
17
18
Index
Snow chains ...................................... 373
Socket
Luggage compartment ................... 329
Sockets
Centre console .............................. 328
General notes ................................ 328
Rear compartment ......................... 329
Specialist workshop ............................ 25
Spectacles compartment ................. 317
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 258
Digital ............................................ 251
In the Instrument cluster ................. 32
Segments ...................................... 246
Selecting a display unit .................. 258
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 203
Display message ............................ 290
Function/notes ............................. 202
Important safety notes .................. 202
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 202
Permanent ..................................... 204
Selecting ........................................ 202
Storing the current speed .............. 203
Variable ......................................... 202
SPEEDTRONIC (variable)
Storing the current speed and
calling up the last stored speed ..... 203
SPORT handling mode
Deactivating/activating
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ................ 78
Warning lamp ................................. 307
Start-off assist
Activating ....................................... 213
Important safety notes .................. 213
Start/Stop button
Removing ....................................... 167
Starting the engine ........................ 168
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 167
STEER CONTROL .................................. 80
Steering
Display message ............................ 299
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL
see STEER CONTROL
Steering wheel
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 118
Button overview ............................... 34
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 247
Cleaning ......................................... 346
Gearshift paddles ........................... 185
Important safety notes .................. 118
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 185
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 263
Stowage compartment
Map pockets .................................. 319
Stowage compartments
Armrest (front) ............................... 318
Armrest (under) ............................. 318
Centre console .............................. 317
Centre console (rear) ..................... 319
Cup holder ..................................... 325
Glove compartment ....................... 317
Important safety information ......... 316
Spectacles compartment ............... 317
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 318
Stowage net ....................................... 319
Stowage space
Stowage net ................................... 319
Summer tyres .................................... 372
Sun visor ............................................ 327
Suspension
Adaptive Damping System ............. 216
Suspension settings
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 215
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 281
see Lights
Tailgate
Display message ............................ 297
Emergency unlocking ..................... 100
Important safety notes .................... 96
Limiting the opening angle ............. 100
Obstruction detection ...................... 97
Opening dimensions ...................... 410
Index
Opening/closing (from outside) ....... 98
Opening/closing automatically
from inside ....................................... 99
Opening/closing automatically
from outside .................................... 98
Technical data
Capacities ...................................... 402
Emergency spare wheel ................. 398
Information .................................... 400
Trailer loads ................................... 412
Tyres/wheels ................................. 384
Vehicle data ................................... 410
Telephone
Accepting a call (multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 254
Display message ............................ 299
Introduction ................................... 254
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 254
Number from the phone book ........ 255
Redialling ....................................... 255
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 254
Telephone compartment ................ 318
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 247
Coolant (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 262
Engine oil (on-board computer,
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ............... 262
Outside temperature ...................... 247
Setting (climate control) ................ 150
Transmission oil (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ..... 262
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 199
Through-loading ................................ 319
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 263
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 353
Tyre pressure not reached ............. 355
Tyre pressure reached ................... 355
Top Tether ............................................ 62
Total distance recorder .................... 250
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 82
Deactivating ..................................... 82
Function ........................................... 81
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 366
Fitting the towing eye .................... 364
Important safety notes .................. 362
Removing the towing eye ............... 364
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 362
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles ............ 366
Transporting the vehicle ................ 365
Towing a trailer
Active Parking Assist ..................... 220
Axle load, permissible .................... 412
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 79
Failure check for LEDs ................... 242
General notes ................................ 239
Pulling away with a trailer .............. 169
Trailer tow hitch display message .. 298
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 364
Removing the towing eye ............... 364
With both axles on the ground ....... 365
With front axle raised ..................... 364
Towing eye ......................................... 351
Traffic Sign Assist
Activating ....................................... 232
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 256
Display message ............................ 289
Function/notes ............................. 231
Important safety notes .................. 232
Instrument cluster display ............. 232
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 242
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 236
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 345
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 241
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 241
Driving tips .................................... 239
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 241
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 240
Important safety notes .................. 237
Lights display message .................. 280
Mounting dimensions .................... 411
Power supply ................................. 242
Trailer loads ................................... 412
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
19
20
Index
see Manual transmission
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ......................
Transporting the vehicle ..................
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signals
Changing bulbs (front) ...................
Changing bulbs (rear) ....................
Switching on/off ...........................
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Information on driving ....................
M+S tyres ......................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Summer tyres ................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
Wheel and tyre combinations ........
see Flat tyre
178
365
346
250
250
251
136
137
129
400
400
400
376
292
355
355
374
375
375
376
377
376
376
376
379
378
313
378
379
371
380
292
384
370
370
372
372
379
371
380
372
384
371
386
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 95
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 94
Upshift indicator (on-board computer, Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ....... 262
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 327
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
see SPEEDTRONIC
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 25
Data acquisition ............................... 26
Display message ............................ 294
Electronics ..................................... 400
Equipment ....................................... 23
Implied warranty .............................. 25
Individual settings .......................... 258
Leaving parked up ......................... 195
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 96
Locking (key) ................................... 87
Lowering ........................................ 383
Pulling away ................................... 168
Raising ........................................... 381
Registration ..................................... 25
Securing from rolling away ............ 381
Transporting .................................. 365
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 95
Unlocking (key) ................................ 87
Vehicle data ................................... 410
Vehicle data
Boot load (maximum) ..................... 410
Index
Roof load (maximum) ..................... 410
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 410
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 96
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 402
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 351
Ventilation
Setting the vents ........................... 161
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 253
VIN
Seat ............................................... 402
Type plate ...................................... 402
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 304
Brakes ........................................... 303
Distance warning signal ................. 312
ESP® .............................................. 306
ESP® OFF ....................................... 307
Fuel tank ........................................ 310
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 200
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 205
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 202
Overview .......................................... 33
PASSENGER AIR BAG ...................... 43
Reserve fuel ................................... 310
Seat belt ........................................ 301
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 313
Warning triangle ................................ 350
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 299
Wheel and tyre combinations
Tyres .............................................. 386
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 383
Wheel chock ...................................... 381
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 379
Changing/replacing ....................... 379
Checking ........................................ 371
Cleaning ......................................... 343
Emergency spare wheel ................. 396
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 383
General notes ................................ 384
Important safety notes .................. 370
Information on driving .................... 370
Removing a wheel .......................... 383
Storing ........................................... 380
Tightening torque ........................... 383
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 384
Windowbag
Display message ............................ 276
Operation ......................................... 51
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 343
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 152
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Important safety notes .................. 409
Topping up ..................................... 339
Windscreen wipers
Display message ............................ 300
Problem (malfunction) ................... 142
Rear window wiper ........................ 138
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 138
Switching on/off ........................... 137
Winter driving
General notes ................................ 372
Winter operation
Slippery road surfaces ................... 198
Snow chains .................................. 373
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 259
M+S tyres ...................................... 372
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 344
Important safety notes .................. 138
Replacing (on the rear window) ..... 140
Replacing (windscreen) .................. 139
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 346
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 151
21
22
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle
to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner in accordance with the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return
your vehicle to these plants free of charge.
This makes a valuable contribution to the
recycling process and the conservation of
resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy,
visit the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Ravoid
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Rdoor
Introduction
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by MercedesBenz. This could lead to malfunctions in
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
or parts of equal quality. Only use tyres,
wheels and accessories that have been specifically approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
therefore accepts no responsibility for the
use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles,
even if they have been officially approved or
independently approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) (Y page 402) when ordering genuine Mercedes-Benz parts.
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
Z
23
24
Introduction
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could affect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly anymore and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could
be damaged without the damage being visible. Components damaged in this way can
unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed for.
If the underbody panelling is damaged,
combustible materials such as leaves,
grass or twigs can gather between the
underbody and the underbody panelling. If
these materials come in contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system, they can catch
fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If, upon con-
tinuing your journey, you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information
systems and communication devices integrated into the vehicle which receive and/or
transmit radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and all other relevant conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Regulation ECE-R 10.
Ra
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it can affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. This may
affect the operating safety of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
Introduction
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
Rservice and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Rmodifications, installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
vehicle technical data
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
Z
25
26
Introduction
QR code for rescue card
The QR code is secured in the fuel filler flap
and on the opposite side on the B-pillar. In the
event of an accident, rescue services can use
the QR code to quickly find the appropriate
rescue card for your vehicle. The current rescue card contains, in a compact form, the
most important information about your vehicle, e.g. the routing of the electric cables.
You can find more information under http://
portal.aftersales.i.daimler.com/public/
content/asportal/en/communication/
informationen_fuer/QRCode.html.
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist in detecting and rectifying faults and
defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an acci-
dent
Roptimise
vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
The vehicle is read out by employees of the
service network (including the manufacturer)
using special diagnostic testers. You can
obtain more information there, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necessary, after consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Rservice
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
Rdamage
Introduction
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
Z
27
28
29
Cockpit ................................................. 30
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 34
Centre console .................................... 36
Door control panel .............................. 39
Overhead control panel ...................... 40
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 32
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
185
;
Combination switch
129
=
Instrument cluster
32
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
177
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
D
Climate control systems
144
E
Ignition lock
165
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
118
G
Cruise control lever
200
H
Electric parking brake
193
I
Light switch
126
216
J
Diagnostics connection
40
K
Opens the bonnet
24
335
31
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
216
=
Combination switch
129
?
Instrument cluster
32
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
177
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
185
40
Function
Page
D
Light switch
126
E
Electric parking brake
193
F
Opens the bonnet
335
G
Diagnostics connection
H
Ignition lock
165
I
Adjusts the steering wheel
118
J
Cruise control lever
200
K
Climate control systems
144
24
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays and controls
i Instrument cluster with speedometer
(km/h)
Function
:
Page
Speedometer
Speedometer segments
246
;
Multifunction display
249
=
Rev counter
247
i Information on displaying the outside
temperature in the multifunction display
can be found under "Outside temperature
display" (Y page 247).
Function
?
Coolant temperature
A
Fuel gauge
Fuel filler flap location indicator æ: the fuel filler
cap is on the left.
B
Instrument cluster lighting
Page
247
246
Instrument cluster
33
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
:
L Dipped-beam headlamps
127
;
T Side lamps
128
=
K Main-beam headlamps
129
?
÷ ESP®
306
A
! Electric parking brake
(red)
309
B
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
C
Function
G
% Diesel engine: preglow
M SPORT handling
mode (Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
Page
168
307
H
? Coolant
310
I
R Rear foglamp
128
J
N Foglamp
127
K
; Engine diagnostics
310
309
L
h Tyre pressure monitor
313
· Distance warning
312
M
æ Reserve fuel
310
D
#! Turn signals
129
N
å ESP® OFF
306
E
6 Restraint system
43
O
! ABS
304
F
ü Seat belt
301
P
J Brakes
303
34
Multifunction steering wheel
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio 20 or COMAND
Online display (see the separate operating instructions)
Page
249
Function
=
?
Vehicles with Audio 20:
switches on voice-operated
control for navigation (see
manufacturer's operating
instructions)
Vehicles with COMAND
Online: switches on LINGUATRONIC (see the separate operating instructions)
8
Mute
WX
Adjusts the volume
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits the telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
Page
254
Multifunction steering wheel
?
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Vehicles with Audio 20:
switches off voice-operated
control of the navigation
(see manufacturer's operating instructions)
Vehicles with COMAND
Online: switches off LINGUATRONIC (see the separate operating instructions)
Page
247
247
247
265
247
At a glance
Function
35
36
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console, upper section
Function
Page
:
Audio 20/COMAND Online;
see the separate operating
instructions
;
c Seat heating
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
AMG RIDE CONTROL (left
side)
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:
adjusts the exhaust flap of
the AMG performance
exhaust system (right side)
117
c PARKTRONIC
216
=
215
172
Function
Page
?
è ECO start/stop function
170
A
£ Hazard warning
lamps
129
B
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamp
C
DYNAMIC SELECT button
å Mercedes-AMG vehicles: ESP®
174
& Auxiliary heating
156
D
43
78
Centre console
37
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
i Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
Function
:
;
Function
Page
Page
=
Cup holders
325
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Stowage compartment
327
328
328
316
?
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
316
A
Stowage compartment
316
Audio/COMAND controller
(see the separate operating
instructions)
Centre console
At a glance
38
i Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Function
:
Function
Page
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Stowage compartment
327
328
328
316
;
Selector lever
180
=
Manual gearshifting (permanent setting)
185
Page
?
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
175
A
Cup holders
325
B
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
316
C
Audio/COMAND controller
(see the separate operating
instructions)
Door control panel
39
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
93
B
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
W Opens/closes the
side windows
94
C
=
r45= Saves
the seat and exterior mirror
settings
122
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the side windows in the
rear compartment
72
?
Adjusts the seats electrically
115
q Opens the luggage
compartment
99
A
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
119
D
102
40
Overhead control panel
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
132
;
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
132
=
| Switches the front
interior lighting/automatic
interior lighting control off
132
?
ë Primes/deactivates
tow-away protection
81
A
Rear-view mirror
B
ê Primes/deactivates
the interior motion sensor
119
82
Function
C
Page
G SOS button
(Mercedes-Benz emergency call system)
329
D
Spectacles compartment
317
E
3 Opens/closes the
panorama sliding sunroof
with roller sunblinds
106
F
c Switches the front
interior lighting on
132
G
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
132
41
Useful information .............................. 42
Panic alarm .......................................... 42
Occupant safety .................................. 42
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 72
Driving safety systems ....................... 72
Protection against theft ..................... 80
Safety
Children in the vehicle ........................ 59
Occupant safety
42
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Safety
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Occupant safety
Introduction to the restraint system
The restraint system can reduce the risk of
vehicle occupants coming into contact with
parts of the vehicle's interior in the event of
an accident. The restraint system can also
reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants
are subjected during an accident.
The restraint system comprises:
RSeat
belt system
RAirbags
RChild
Panic alarm
restraint system
seat securing systems
The components of the restraint system work
in conjunction with each other. They can only
deploy their protective function if all vehicle
occupants always:
RChild
Rfasten
To activate: press and hold the
! button : for approx. one second.
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed.
X To deactivate: press the ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS‑GO
X Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
X
The panic alarm function is only available in
certain countries.
their seat belts correctly
(Y page 46)
Radjust their seat and head restraint properly (Y page 113).
As the driver, you also have to make sure that
the steering wheel is adjusted correctly.
Observe the information relating to the correct driver's seat position (Y page 112).
You also have to make sure that an airbag can
inflate properly if deployed (Y page 48).
An airbag supplements a correctly fastened
seat belt. As an additional safety device, the
airbag increases the level of protection for
vehicle occupants in the event of an accident.
For example, if the protection of the seat belt
is sufficient in an accident, the airbags are not
deployed. In the event of an accident, only the
airbags that increase protection in the relevant accident situation are deployed. However, seat belts and airbags generally do not
protect against objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Information on the restraint system operation
can be found under "Triggering of belt tensioners and airbags" (Y page 57).
For more information about children travelling with you in the vehicle, see "Children in
the vehicle" (Y page 59).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the restraint system is modified, it may no
longer work as intended. The restraint system
may then not perform its intended protective
function by failing in an accident or triggering
unexpectedly, for example. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify parts of the restraint system. Do
not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
G WARNING
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This can
effect belt tensioners or airbags, for example.
There is an increased risk of serious or even
fatal injuries.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp
If it is necessary to modify an airbag system to
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for
details.
Restraint system warning lamp
The functions of the restraint system are
checked after the ignition is switched on and
at regular intervals while the engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in good time.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a
few seconds after the vehicle is started. The
components of the restraint system are in
operational readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6
restraint system warning lamp:
Rdoes
not light up after the ignition is
switched on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds with
the engine running
Rlights up again while the engine is running
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp :
and PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp ; are part of the automatic deactivation system of the front-passenger front airbag.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag.
RPASSENGER
AIR BAG ON lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. If,
in the event of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
airbag is deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident.
Z
43
Safety
Occupant safety
44
Occupant safety
Safety
Depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front airbag must either be disabled or enabled; see
the following points. You must make sure of
this both before and during a journey.
RChildren
in a rearward-facing child
restraint system: the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit. The
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
is imperative to observe the notes on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 51) and on
"Children in the vehicle" (Y page 59).
RChildren in a forward-facing child
restraint system: depending on the installed child restraint system and the age and
size of the child, the front-passenger front
airbag is either disabled or enabled. Therefore, it is imperative to observe the notes
on the "Automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system" (Y page 51)
and on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 59).
RAll other persons: the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp must be lit. The
front-passenger front airbag is enabled.
Depending on the build of the person on the
front-passenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp may light up. The
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident. In this case, the front-passenger
seat should not be used.
It is imperative to observe the notes on the
"Automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system" (Y page 51) as well
as on "Seat belts" (Y page 44) and "Airbags" (Y page 48). There you can also find
information on the correct seat position.
Seat belts
Introduction
A correctly worn seat belt is the most effective means of restraining the movement of
vehicle occupants in the event of a collision or
if the vehicle overturns. This reduces the risk
of vehicle occupants coming into contact with
parts of the vehicle interior or being ejected
from it. The seat belt also helps to keep the
vehicle occupants in the best position in relation to the airbag being deployed.
The seat belt system consists of:
Rseat
belts
tensioners for the front seat belts and
the outer seat belts in the rear
Rbelt force limiters for the front seat belts
and the outer seat belts in the rear
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or sharply
from the belt outlet, the inertia reel locks. The
belt strap cannot be pulled out any further.
The belt tensioner tightens the seat belt in the
event of a collision so that it fits tightly across
your body. However, it does not pull the vehicle occupants back in the direction of the seat
backrest.
The belt tensioner does not, however, correct
an incorrect seat position or correct the routing of a seat belt that is worn incorrectly.
When triggered, seat belt force limiters help
to reduce the peak force exerted by the seat
belt on the vehicle occupant.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which
take on a part of the deceleration force. This
can reduce the forces to which the vehicle
occupants are subjected during an accident.
Rbelt
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do
not engage the seat belt tongue in the
buckle on the co-driver's seat. Otherwise,
the belt tensioner could be triggered in the
event of an accident and would have to be
replaced.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The seat belt cannot perform its intended protective function if it is not fastened correctly.
Also, an improperly fastened seat belt can
cause additional injuries in the event of an
accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes
of direction. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Always make sure that all vehicle occupants
are wearing their seat belt properly and are
seated correctly.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly without a suitable, additional restraint system. The seat belt cannot
perform its intended protective function if it is
not fastened correctly. Also, an improperly
fastened seat belt can cause additional injuries in the event of an accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes of direction. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in a suitable restraint system.
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the
vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz
vehicle. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child.
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 51)
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes on "Children in the vehicle" in this
Owner's Manual (Y page 59) in addition
to the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot protect as intended, if:
Rthey are damaged, have been modified, are
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or inertia reels
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters. Modified or damaged seat belts can tear or fail, for
example in the event of an accident. Modified
seat belt tensioners may be deployed unintentionally or fail to be deployed when
required. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never modify safety belts, seat belt tensioners, seat belt anchorages and inertia reels.
Ensure that seat belts are not damaged or
worn and are clean. After an accident, have
the seat belts checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use seat belts which have been approved
specifically for your vehicle by MercedesBenz. Otherwise, your vehicle's general operating permit could be invalidated.
Sports seat or AMG Performance seat: this
seat is designed for the standard three-point
seat belt. If you fit another multipoint seat
belt, e.g. sport or racing seat belts, the
restraint system cannot provide the best level
of protection.
G WARNING
If you feed seat belts through the opening in
the seat backrest, the seat backrest may be
damaged or may even break in the event of an
Z
45
Safety
Occupant safety
46
Occupant safety
Safety
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Only use the standard three-point seat belt.
Never modify the seat belt system.
Correct seat belt use
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44).
All vehicle occupants must be wearing the
seat belt correctly before beginning the journey. Also make sure that all vehicle occupants are always wearing the seat belt correctly while the vehicle is in motion.
When fastening the seat belt, always make
sure that:
Infants and children must never travel sitting on the lap of a vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat
belt.
Robjects are never secured with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants
Also ensure that no objects are placed
between a person and the seat. e.g. a cushion.
Seat belts are only intended to secure and
restrain vehicle occupants. Always observe
the "Loading guidelines" for securing objects,
luggage or loads (Y page 316).
Rthe seat belt tongue is only inserted into the
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
Rthe
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44) and the information on the correct use of the seat belt (Y page 46).
belt buckle belonging to that seat
seat belt is tight across your body
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted
Only then can forces which occur be distributed across the surface of the seat belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the centre of your shoulder
The shoulder section of the seat belt should
not touch your neck nor be routed under
your arm. If possible, adjust the seat belt to
the appropriate height.
Rthe lap belt passes across your lap as
tightly and as low down as possible
The lap belt must always be routed across
your hip joints and never across your abdomen. This applies particularly to pregnant
women. If necessary, press the lap belt
down into your hip joints and pull tight with
the shoulder section of the belt.
Rthe seat belt is not routed across sharp,
pointed or fragile objects
If you have such items located on or in your
clothing, e.g. pens, keys or spectacles,
store these in a suitable place.
Ronly one person is using a seat belt
Basic illustration
Adjust the seat (Y page 112).
The seat backrest must be in an almost
vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from belt outlet
=.
X Engage seat belt tongue ; in belt
buckle :.
The seat belt on the driver's seat and the
front-passenger seat may be tightened
X
Occupant safety
The shoulder section of the seat belt must
always be routed across the centre of the
shoulder. Adjust the belt outlet if necessary.
To raise: slide the belt outlet upwards.
The belt outlet will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt outlet release ? and
slide belt outlet downwards.
X Let go of belt outlet release ? in the
desired position and make sure that the
belt outlet engages.
X
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Safety
automatically; see "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 47).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
47
Basic illustration
X
Press release button :, hold belt
tongue ; firmly and guide it back towards
belt outlet =.
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. This
function adjusts the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt to the upper body of the
occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Rthe
seat belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle and
Rthe ignition is switched on
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the vehicle occupant and the seat
belt. Do not hold on to the seat belt tightly
while it is adjusting.
You can switch the seat-belt adjustment on
and off in the on-board computer
(Y page 261).
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster reminds you that all vehicle
occupants must fasten their seat belts. It may
Z
Safety
48
Occupant safety
light up continuously or flash. A warning tone
may also sound.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone stops as soon as the driver's
and the co-driver's seat belts have been fastened.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see "Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 301).
Rear seat belt status indicator
An airbag supplements a correctly worn seat
belt. It is not a replacement for the seat belt.
The airbag offers additional protection in
applicable accident situations.
Not all airbags are deployed in an accident.
The different airbag systems work independently of each other (Y page 57).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
It is also not possible to completely rule out a
risk of injury caused by an airbag due to the
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The seat belts on the left and centre rear
seats, when viewed in the direction of travel,
are not fastened. (Example)
The rear seat belt status indicator is only
available for certain countries.
For approximately 30 seconds, the rear seat
belt status indicator informs you which rear
seat belt is not fastened.
The rear seat belt status indicator appears if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
you pull away again
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 265).
Airbags
Introduction
The installation location of an airbag is identified by the AIRBAG symbol.
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended protective function and can even cause additional injuries when deployed. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
In order to avoid such risks, always ensure
that all vehicle occupants:
Rfasten
their seatbelts correctly, including
pregnant women
Rare seated correctly and maintain the furthest possible distance from the airbags
Robserve the following notes
Always ensure that there are no objects located between the airbag and the vehicle occupant.
RAdjust
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the
seat is in an almost upright position. The
centre of the head restraint must support
the head at about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger
seats as far back as possible. The driver's
seat position must allow the vehicle to be
driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside. This allows the airbag to be fully
deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against
Occupant safety
RAlways
secure children under twelve years
of age and less than 1.50 m tall in suitable
child restraint systems.
RChild restraint systems should be fitted to
the rear seats.
ROnly secure a child to the front-passenger
seat when the front-passenger front airbag
is disabled, and only then in a rearwardfacing child restraint system. If the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
permanently lit, the front-passenger front
airbag is disabled (Y page 43).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 51) and on "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 59) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent the airbag from functioning correctly. Before starting your journey and to
avoid risks resulting from the speed of the
airbag as it deploys, make sure that:
Rthere
are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an airbag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, are
hanging on the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno
accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment area of an airbag, e.g. to doors, side
windows, rear side trim or side walls.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects
are in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
G WARNING
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an airbag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied.
In the event of an accident, the restraint
systems on the front-passenger side may
be triggered and have to be replaced.
Z
Safety
the door or side window. You may otherwise be in the deployment area of the airbags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in
front of the seat. Do not put your feet on the
dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise be in the deployment area of the
airbag.
RAlways secure persons less than 1.50 m tall
in suitable restraint systems. Up to this
height, the seat belt cannot be worn correctly.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
49
Occupant safety
Driver's kneebag : deploys under the steering column. The driver's kneebag is triggered
together with the front airbags.
The driver's kneebag offers additional thigh,
knee and lower leg protection for the occupant in the driver's seat.
Safety
50
i The driver's kneebag is only available in
certain countries.
Sidebags
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel. Front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
When deployed, the front airbags offer additional head and thorax protection for the
occupants in the front seats.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
inform you about the status of the frontpassenger front airbag (Y page 43).
The front-passenger front airbag will only
deploy if:
Rthe
automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system has detected that the
front-passenger seat is occupied
(Y page 51). The PASSENGER AIR BAG
ON indicator lamp is lit (Y page 52)
Rthe restraint system control unit predicts a
high accident severity
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers can obstruct or prevent the deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. Consequently, the airbags cannot protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. In addition, the function of the
automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system could be restricted. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for the corresponding seats by
Mercedes-Benz.
Driver's kneebag
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer bolster of the seat
backrest.
When deployed, the sidebag offers additional
thorax protection. It also offers additional pelvis protection for occupants in the front
seats. However, it does not protect the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
Occupant safety
Ran
occupant is detected on the frontpassenger seat or
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
If the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle, the sidebag on the front-passenger
side deploys if an appropriate accident situation occurs. In this case, deployment is independent of whether the front-passenger seat
is occupied or not.
Windowbags
Windowbags : are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deploy in the area from
the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
When deployed, the windowbag enhances the
level of protection for the head. However, it
does not protect the chest or arms.
In the event of a side impact, the windowbag
is deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
If the system determines that they can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt, a windowbag may be deployed in
other accident situations (Y page 57).
Automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Introduction
In order to recognise a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat, the automatic
front-passenger front airbag deactivation system categorises the person in the frontpassenger seat. Depending on that result, the
front-passenger front airbag is either enabled
or disabled. If a rearward-facing child
restraint system is fitted to the frontpassenger seat, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up after the
system self-test and remain lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
The system does not disable:
Rthe
sidebag
windowbag
Rthe seat belt tensioner
Make sure that your vehicle is equipped with
the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system (Y page 63). If this is
not the case, always install a child restraint
system on a suitable rear seat (Y page 65).
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
be sure to observe the correct positioning of
the child restraint system. Never place
objects under or behind the child restraint
system, e.g. a cushion. Fully retract the seat
cushion length. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion of the front-passenger seat. The
backrest of the forward-facing child restraint
system must, as far as possible, be resting on
the backrest of the front-passenger seat. The
child restraint system must not touch the roof
or be put under strain by the head restraint.
Adjust the angle of the seat backrest and the
head restraint position accordingly. Only then
is the correct function of the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
guaranteed. Always observe the information
on suitable positioning of the child restraint
system (Y page 65) in addition to the child
Rthe
Z
Safety
In the event of a side impact, the sidebag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
airbag deactivation system: the sidebag on
the front-passenger side deploys under the
following conditions:
51
Occupant safety
52
restraint system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Safety
Operation of automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation
tion to the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamps. Be
aware of the status of the front-passenger
front airbag both before and during the journey.
If a person sits in the passenger seat, they
must be:
Rseated with the seat belt fastened correctly
Rin
: PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
The indicator lamps inform you whether the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled or
enabled.
X
Press the Start/Stop button once or twice,
or turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
The system carries out a self-diagnosis.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front airbag:
RPASSENGER
AIR BAG ON lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is enabled. If,
in the event of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
airbag is deployed.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up: the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It
will then not be deployed in the event of an
accident.
If the status of the front-passenger front airbag changes while the vehicle is in motion, an
airbag display message appears in the instrument cluster (Y page 278). When the frontpassenger seat is occupied, always pay atten-
an almost upright position with their
back against the seat backrest
Rwith their feet resting on the floor, if possible
If the front passenger does not observe these
conditions, the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system may be influenced, e.g. because the front passenger:
Rtransfers
their weight by supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest
Rsits in such a way that their weight is raised
from the seat cushion
The front-passenger front airbag may be disabled by mistake as a result of these or similar
actions. In this case, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up permanently. The front-passenger front airbag does
not then deploy during an accident.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of an
accident and cannot perform its intended protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always make sure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and that the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disa-
bled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible.
Rthe person is seated correctly.
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front-passenger
front airbag is correct.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains off and/or the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install
a rearward-facing child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat. Further information
can be found under "Problems with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system" (Y page 56).
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is lit
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Always move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible and fully retract the seat
cushion length. Always make sure that the
shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the vehicle belt outlet. If
necessary, adjust the vehicle belt outlet and
the front-passenger seat accordingly. Always
observe the information about suitable positioning of the child restraint system in this
Owner's Manual as well as the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system detects that:
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a rearward-facing child restraint
system, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up after the system selftest and remains lit. This indicates that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled.
But in the case of a child in a rearwardfacing child restraint, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp can light up after
the system self-test and remain lit. This
indicates that the front-passenger front airbag is enabled. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors,
the child restraint system and the child's
build. It is recommended that you fit the
child restraint system to a suitable rear
seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child in a forward-facing child restraint system, either the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON or
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up and remains lit after the system
self-test depending on the result of the
classification. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors,
the child restraint system and the child's
build.
Z
53
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
54
Occupant safety
Move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. Always observe the information in "Child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 63) and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system" (Y page 65). Alternatively, you can
fit the child restraint system to a suitable
rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
person with a smaller build (e.g. a teenager
or small adult), either the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON or PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up and remains lit after
the system self-test depending on the
result of the classification.
- if the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp lights up, move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. Alternatively, a person with a small build can sit
on a rear seat.
- if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, a person with a smaller build
should not use the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person with a build corresponding to that of an adult, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up after the
system self-test and remains lit. This indicates that the front-passenger front airbag
is enabled.
If children are travelling in the vehicle, be sure
to observe the notes on "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 59).
If the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation system is malfunctioning, the
red 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster and the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp light up simultaneously. The front-passenger front airbag is
disabled in this case and does not deploy during an accident. Have the system checked as
soon as possible by qualified technicians.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. The
front-passenger seat should only be repaired
at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
If the front-passenger seat, the seat cover or
the seat cushion is damaged, have the necessary repair work carried out at a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system which has been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz in combination with the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system.
System self-test
G DANGER
If both the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps do
not light up during the system self-test, the
system is malfunctioning. The frontpassenger front airbag might be triggered
unintentionally or might not be triggered at all
in the event of an accident with high deceleration. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Do not install a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat. Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
remains lit after the system self-test, the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger front airbag
cannot perform its intended protective function, e.g. when a person is seated in the frontpassenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle's interior, especially
if the person is sitting too close to the dashboard. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Occupant safety
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
55
front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 56).
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
Safety
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front airbag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat.
Rthe person is seated properly with a correctly fastened seat belt.
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit when it should not, the frontpassenger seat may not be used. Do not
install a child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. Have the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects between the seat surface and the
child restraint system could affect the function of the automatic front-passenger front
airbag deactivation system. This could result
in the front-passenger front airbag not functioning as intended during an accident. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Do not place any objects between the seat
surface and the child restraint system. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the forwardsfacing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, be resting on the backrest of the
rear reclining seat. Always comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
After the system self-test, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF or PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp then shows the status of the
co-driver's front airbag (Y page 52).
Further information can be obtained under
"Problems with the automatic co-driver's
Z
56
Occupant safety
Problems with automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Be sure to observe the notes on "System self-test" (Y page 54).
Safety
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
The classification of the person on the front-passenger seat is
BAG OFF indicator
false.
lamp lights up and
X Make sure the conditions for a correct classification of the perremains lit, even
son on the front-passenger seat are met (Y page 52).
though the frontX If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the
passenger seat is occufront-passenger seat may not be used.
pied by an adult or a
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
person with a build corsystem checked as soon as possible at a Mercedes-Benz Serresponding to that of an
vice Centre.
adult.
The PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator
lamp does not light up
and/or does not stay
on.
The front-passenger
seat is:
The automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system is
malfunctioning.
X Make sure there is nothing between the seat and the child
restraint system.
X Make sure that the entire base of the child restraint system rests
on the seat cushion of the front-passenger seat.
X Make sure that the seat cushion length is fully retracted.
Rempty
X When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the
Roccupied with a rearseat belt is tight. Do not pull the seat belt tight with the frontward-facing child
passenger seat adjustment. This could result in the seat belt and
restraint system
the child restraint system being pulled too tightly.
X Check that the child restraint system is installed correctly.
X Make sure that no objects are applying additional weight to the
seat.
X If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains off and/
or the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not
install a rearward-facing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. It is recommended that you fit the child
restraint system to a suitable rear seat.
X Have the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system checked as soon as possible at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
After the airbag deploys, the airbag parts are
hot. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have a
deployed airbag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners that have
been deployed are no longer operational and
are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic belt tensioners
which have been triggered immediately
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the vehicle towed to a qualified specialist
workshop after an accident. Take this into
account, particularly if a seat belt tensioner
was triggered or an airbag was deployed.
An electric motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to
trigger the tightening of the seat belt in hazardous situations. This procedure is reversible.
If the belt tensioners are triggered or an airbag is deployed, you will hear a bang, and a
small amount of powder may also be
released. The 6 restraint system warning
lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your
hearing. In general, the powder released is
not hazardous to health but may cause shortterm breathing difficulties to persons suffering from asthma or other pulmonary conditions. Provided it is safe to do so, you should
leave the vehicle immediately or open the
window in order to prevent breathing difficulties.
Operation
During the first stage of a collision, the
restraint system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the
restraint system control unit triggers the seat
belt tensioners in the event of a head-on or
rear collision.
A seat belt tensioner can only be triggered if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational. You can find further information under: "Restraint system warning
lamp" (Y page 43)
Rthe belt tongue has engaged in the belt
buckle of the respective front seat
The seat belt tensioners in the rear compartment are triggered independently of the lock
status of the seat belts.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
high severity accident, in certain head-on collisions, additional components of the
restraint system are deployed independently
of each other:
Rfront airbags and driver's kneebag
Rwindowbag, if the system determines that
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
On vehicles with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system:
depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front airbag is either disabled or enabled. The frontpassenger front airbag can only be deployed
in an accident if the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp is lit. Observe the information
on the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps
(Y page 43).
Your vehicle has two-stage front airbags. In
the first deployment stage, the front airbag is
Z
Safety
Deployment of belt tensioners and airbags
57
Safety
58
Occupant safety
filled with propellant gas to reduce the risk of
injuries. The front airbag is fully deployed if
the second deployment stage is activated
within a few milliseconds.
The activation threshold for the seat belt tensioners and airbags is determined based on
the evaluation of the vehicle's rate of deceleration or acceleration at various points in the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering/deployment process should
take place in good time at the start of the
collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly
without an airbag being deployed. This is the
case if only parts which are relatively easily
deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high. Conversely, an airbag may
be deployed even though the vehicle suffers
only minor deformation. This is the case if, for
example, very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are hit, and sufficient
deceleration occurs as a result.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
side impact, the applicable components of
the restraint system are activated independently of each other.
RSidebags on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent from the seat belt tensioner and seat belt usage
Vehicles with the automatic frontpassenger airbag deactivation system: the
sidebag on the front-passenger side
deploys under the following conditions:
- an occupant is detected on the frontpassenger seat or
- the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
RWindowbag on the side on which an impact
occurs, independent of seat belt usage and
regardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
RSeat belt tensioners, if the system determines that deployment can offer additional
protection for the vehicle occupants in this
situation
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal
Rside
collision
impact
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Introduction
In certain hazardous situations, PRE-SAFE®
takes pre-emptive measures to protect the
vehicle occupants.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats. There is a risk
that the seats and/or the objects could be
damaged when PRE-SAFE® is activated.
Although your vehicle is equipped with PRESAFE®, the possibility of injury in the event of
an accident cannot be ruled out. Always
adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road and weather conditions and maintain a
Children in the vehicle
Automatic measures after an accident
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures may be implemented, depending
on the type and severity of the impact:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
Rthe
Function
BAS is activated
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when physical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely
Ron vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: if adaptive Brake Assist intervenes powerfully
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
the vehicle skids, the side windows and
the panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
Rvehicles with the memory function: the
front-passenger seat is adjusted if it is in an
unfavourable position.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pre-tensioning. All settings made by
PRE-SAFE® can then be reversed.
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced:
Rif
X
Move the seat backrest or seat back
slightly when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. Information about the convenience function can
be found under "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 47).
hazard warning lamps are activated
emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rthe engine is switched off and the fuel supply is cut off
Rvehicles with the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system: automatic emergency
call
Rthe
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat. Children are generally better protected there.
If a child younger than twelve years old and
under 1.50 m in height is travelling in the
vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child.
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes in this section in addition to
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions.
Ralways pay attention to the instructions
and safety notes on the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system
(Y page 51).
Z
Safety
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
59
60
Children in the vehicle
Safety
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly. Particular attention must be
paid to children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44) and the information on the correct use of the seat belt (Y page 46).
Child restraint system
If you fit a rearward-facing child restraint system to the centre rear seat, the rear arm rest
must be folded back as far as possible.
Observe the instructions for correct use of
the child restraint system (Y page 65).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(Y page 69).
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
You will find further information on stowing
objects, luggage and loads securely under
"Loading guidelines" (Y page 316).
The securing systems of child restraint systems are:
seat belt system
ISOFIX or i-Size securing rings
Rthe Top Tether anchorages
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a child
restraint system to the front-passenger seat,
always observe the information on "Child
restraint systems on the front-passenger
seat" (Y page 63).
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
61
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems or i-Size child
restraint systems with which the child is also
secured with the vehicle seat belt. Also secure
the child restraint system with the Top Tether
belt, if available.
Safety
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
Children in the vehicle
When fitting a child restraint system, be sure
to observe the manufacturer's installation
and operating instructions and the instructions for correct use of the child restraint system (Y page 65).
Before every trip, make sure that the ISOFIX
child restraint system is engaged correctly in
both ISOFIX securing rings.
Rthe
Rthe
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. You can
obtain information about this at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
This symbol indicates an ISOFIX position
which is suitable for attaching an ISOFIX child
restraint system. A similar symbol can be
found on the ISOFIX child restraint system.
ISOFIX and i-Size child restraint systems
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems or i-Size child
restraint systems do not offer sufficient protection for children whose weight is greater
than 22 kg, who are secured using the safety
belt integrated in the child restraint system.
The child could, for example, not be restrained
correctly in the event of an accident. This
This symbol indicates an i‑Size position which
is suitable for attaching an i-Size child
restraint system. A similar symbol can be
found on the i-Size child restraint system.
Z
Children in the vehicle
62
! When fitting the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the centre
seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the
seat belt could be damaged.
rings. ISOFIX securing ring : or i-Size securing ring ; are installed on the left and right
sides of the rear seats.
Safety
Top Tether
Introduction
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the vehicle. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further. If the child
restraint system is fitted with a Top Tether
belt, this should always be used.
: ISOFIX securing rings
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings : or i-Size
securing rings ;.
G WARNING
If the rear seat backrests are not locked, they
could fold forwards in the event of an accident, heavy braking or sudden changes of
direction. As a result, child restraint systems
cannot perform their intended protective
function. Rear seat backrests that are not
locked can also cause additional injuries, e.g.
in the event of an accident. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always lock rear seat backrests after fitting a
Top Tether belt. Observe the lock verification
indicator. Adjust the rear seat backrests so
that they are in an upright position.
Install the i-Size child restraint system on
both i-Size securing rings ;.
If the rear backrest is not engaged and
locked, the red lock verification indicator will
be visible (Y page 319).
; i-Size securing rings
X
or
X
Important safety notes
ISOFIX and i-Size are standardised securing
systems for special child restraint systems.
ISOFIX child restraint systems are approved
in accordance with ECE R-44. i-Size child
restraint systems are approved in accordance with ECE R-129.
Only child restraint systems that have been
approved in accordance with ECE R-44 may
be attached to ISOFIX securing rings. i-Size
child restraint systems that have been
approved in accordance with ECE R-44 and
ECE R-129 may be attached to i-Size securing
Top Tether anchorages
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Hook Top Tether hook = of Top Tether
belt ? into Top Tether anchorage ;.
Ensure that:
RTop
The Top Tether anchorage points are located
on the rear side of the backrests on both
outer rear seats.
Tether hook = is hooked into Top
Tether anchorage ; as shown
RTop Tether belt ? is not twisted
RTop Tether belt ? is routed between the
rear seat backrest and the luggage compartment cover if the luggage compartment cover is fitted
X Tension Top Tether belt ?. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
Vehicles with adjustable head restraints:
X
If necessary, move head restraint : back
down again slightly (Y page 116). Make
sure that you do not interfere with the correct routing of Top Tether belt ?.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
Vehicles with adjustable head restraints:
X
X
Move head restraint : upwards.
Route Top Tether belt ? under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
Vehicles without adjustable head
restraints:
X
Top Tether belt with one belt strap: route
Top Tether belt ? centrally over head
restraint :.
or
X
Top Tether belt with two belt straps:
route one Top Tether belt ? to the left and
one to the right past the side of head
restraint :.
General notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat.
Vehicles with the automatic front-passenger
front airbag deactivation system: if it is absolutely necessary to fit a child restraint system
to the front-passenger seat, always observe
the information on the "Automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system"
(Y page 51).
All vehicles:
X
Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Always comply with the child
Z
63
Safety
Children in the vehicle
64
Children in the vehicle
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise
as a result of:
Safety
Ra child restraint system that is not detected
Vehicles without the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation
system
by the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system
Rthe unintentional disabling of the frontpassenger front airbag
Rthe unsuitable positioning of the child
restraint system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Please observe the warning notice on the
front-passenger sun visor, see the illustration.
G WARNING
If you secure a child on the co-driver's seat in
a rearward-facing child restraint system and
the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
lights up, the co-driver's airbag could be
deployed in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
In this case, always ensure that the co-driver's
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must light up.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
front of it; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is enabled (Y page 43).
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is
not equipped with the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system,
this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. The sticker is
visible when you open the front-passenger
door.
If you turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
light up briefly. However, they have no function and do not indicate that there is an automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system.
Always fit the rearward-facing restraint system to a suitable rear seat in this case
(Y page 65).
Observe the following information under
"Rearward-facing child restraint system" and
"Forward-facing child restraint system" as
well as information on the suitable positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 65).
Rearward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a rearwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always make sure that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. Only
if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit continuously (Y page 43)is the
front-passenger front airbag disabled.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 65) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Forward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a forwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible. Fully
retract the seat cushion length. The entire
base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the child
restraint system must, as far as possible, lie
flat against the backrest of the frontpassenger seat. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof or be put under strain
by the head restraint. Adjust the angle of the
seat backrest and the head restraint position
accordingly. Always make sure that the shoulder belt strap is correctly routed from the
vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt guide
on the child restraint system. The shoulder
belt strap must be routed forwards and downwards from the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary, adjust the vehicle belt outlet and the
front-passenger seat accordingly.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 65) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint system
Introduction
Only child restraint systems approved in
accordance with the ECE standards ECE R44
or ECE R129 (i-Size child restraint systems)
are permitted for use in the vehicle.
For certain child restraint systems in weight
categories II or III, this can mean that the area
of use is restricted. The maximum size setting
of the child restraint system is not possible
due to possible contact with the roof.
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label and the text "Universal" or an "i-Size"
label.
Example: approval labels on the child
restraint system
ISOFIX or i-Size child restraint systems of the
“Universal“ category can be used on seats
labelled U, UF, IUF or i-U in accordance with
the following tables:
RSuitability
of the seats for attaching beltsecured child restraint systems
RSuitability of the seats for attaching ISOFIX
child restraint systems
RSuitability of the seats for attaching an iSize child restraint system.
Semi-universal child restraint systems are
indicated by the text "semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehiZ
65
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
Safety
66
cle and the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For
more information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat – if it is absolutely necessary
to secure a child in a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat:
Always pay attention to the instructions
under "Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 63).
There you will find instructions on how to
correctly route the shoulder belt strap from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system
(Y page 65).
X Move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible and fully retract the seat cushion length.
If you secure a child in a forward-facing
child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat, you must also move the
front-passenger seat to the highest position.
X Move the backrest to an almost vertical
position.
The entire base of the child restraint system must always rest on the seat cushion of
the front-passenger seat. The backrest of
the forward-facing child restraint system
must, as far as possible, be resting on the
backrest of the front-passenger seat. The
child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraint. Adjust the angle of the seat backrest and the head restraint position accordingly. Also observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
X If possible, move the seat cushion angle to
the highest, most vertical position
(Y page 114).
X
Installing a child restraint system on a
rear seat
X
Move the backrest of the rear seat to an
almost vertical position (Y page 320).
Children in the vehicle
67
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of
category I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat
does not touch the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head
restraint of the respective seat (Y page 116), if possible. The backrest of the child restraint
system must, as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 60) and the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system you must replace the head restraints again
immediately (Y page 115). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly
before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X
U
Seat which is unsuitable for children in this weight category.
Suitable for child restraint systems in the "Universal" category that are approved for use
in this weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category
and are approved for use in this weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as recommended; see the "Recommended child
restraint systems" table (Y page 69). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint systems
if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's vehicle
model list.
Weight category
Front-passenger seat
Rear seat
Frontpassenger
front airbag
enabled
Frontpassenger
front airbag
deactivated1
Left, right
Centre2
0
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
U, L
U, L
0+
up to 13 kg
X
U, L
U, L
U, L
I
9 kg to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
U, L
U, L
II
15 kg to 25 kg
U, L
U, L
U, L
X
III
22 kg to 36 kg
U, L
U, L
U, L
X
The vehicle is equipped with an automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation system. The PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
2 Child restraint systems with a supporting bracket are not suitable for this seat.
1
Z
Safety
Suitability of the seats for attaching a belt-secured child restraint system
Children in the vehicle
68
Safety
Suitability of the seats for attaching ISOFIX child restraint systems
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of
category I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat
does not touch the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head
restraint of the respective seat (Y page 116), if possible. The backrest of the child restraint
system must, as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 60) and the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system you must replace the head restraints again
immediately (Y page 115). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly
before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child seat securing systems that belong to the "Universal" category which are approved for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the "Recommended
child restraint systems" table (Y page 69).
The manufacturer will also recommend a suitable ISOFIX child restraint system. For this,
your vehicle and the seat must be listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's
model list. For more information, contact the child restraint system manufacturer or visit
their website.
Weight category
Carry-cot
Equipment
Rear seat left,
right
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
0
up to 10 kg
up to approximately 6 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
0+
up to 13 kg
up to approximately 15 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL3
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL3
B
ISO/F2
IUF
I
3
Size category
9 kg to 18 kg
between approximately
9 months and 4 years
If you are using a child restraint system of size category C (ISO/R3), make sure that the front seat backrest
does not rest against the child restraint system.
Weight category
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat left,
right
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
The child restraint system must not touch the roof or be put under strain by the head restraints.
Adjust the head restraint position accordingly. Also observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Suitability of the seats for attaching an i-Size child restraint system
If you use a baby car seat of category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system of
category I on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat
does not touch the child restraint system.
If you use a category I, forward-facing child restraint system, you should remove the head
restraint of the respective seat (Y page 116), if possible. The backrest of the child restraint
system must, as far as possible, lie flat against the backrest of the seat.
Always observe the notes in the "Child restraint system" section (Y page 60) and the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
When you remove the child restraint system you must replace the head restraints again
immediately (Y page 115). All vehicle occupants must adjust their head restraints correctly
before beginning the journey.
Legend for the table:
X Seat which is unsuitable for i-Size child restraint systems in the "Universal" category.
i‑U Suitable for a forward or rearward-facing i-Size child restraint system in the "Universal"
category.
Seat
i‑Size child restraint systems
Frontpassenger
seat
Rear seat
Left
Centre
Right
X
i‑U
X
i‑U
Recommended child restraint systems
General notes
Always observe the information in "Child restraint systems on the front-passenger seat"
(Y page 63) and in "Suitable positioning of the child restraint system" (Y page 65).
You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
69
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
70
Safety
Recommended child restraint systems for attaching with the vehicle seat belt
Weight category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval number (E1 ...)
Order number
(A 000 ...)4
Category 0: up to
10 kg
up to approximately 6 months
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus II
04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
Category 0+: up to
13 kg
up to approximately
15 months
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus II
04 301146
970 20 00
970 36 00
Group I: 9 kg to
18 kg
between approximately 9 months
and 4 years
Britax Römer
DUO plus
03 301133
04 301133
970 16 00
Group II/III: 15 kg
to 36 kg
between approximately 4and
12 years
Britax Römer
KIDFIX5
04 301198
970 19 00
Recommended "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems
4
5
Weight cat- Size
egory
category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order number4
Category
E
0+:
up to 13 kg
Britax Römer
BABY SAFE
plus
03 301146
04 301146
B6 6 86 8224
Category I:
9 kg to
18 kg
Britax Römer
DUO plus
03 301133
04 301133
A 000 970 16 00
B1
Colour code 9H95.
Before fitting the KIDFIX child restraint system in the vehicle, always observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions. These will also include notes on fixing options.
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are travelling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Roperate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are travelling in the
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for:
Rthe
Rthe
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
rear doors (Y page 71)
rear side windows (Y page 72)
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Z
Safety
Child-proof locks
71
Driving safety systems
72
Override feature for the rear side windows
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
Safety
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
X
To enable/disable: press button :.
If indicator lamp ; is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp ; is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 73)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 73)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(Y page 73)
RAdaptive brake lights (Y page 76)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 76)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 80)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 80)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 80)
Important safety notes
Pets in the vehicle
G WARNING
If you leave animals unsupervised or unsecured in the vehicle, they may push a button
or a switch, for example.
They could:
Ractivate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Rswitch vehicle systems on or off, thus
endangering other road users
In the event of an accident, sudden braking or
abrupt changes of direction, unsecured animals could be flung around the vehicle, injuring the vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals correctly during a
journey, e.g. in an animal transport box.
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. Driving safety
systems are merely aids designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for maintaining
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time, and for staying in lane. Always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions and maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there is
adequate contact between the tyres and the
road surface. Please pay special attention to
the notes on tyres, recommended minimum
tyre tread depths etc. (Y page 370).
In wintry driving conditions, always use winter
tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary, snow
chains. Only in this way will the driving safety
systems described in this section work as
effectively as possible.
Driving safety systems
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h,
regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS
works on slippery surfaces, even when you
only brake gently.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 304) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 266).
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions; this serves
as a reminder to take extra care while driving.
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Braking
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS
Brakes
General notes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
tion (Y page 72).
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS consists of a distance warning function with an
autonomous braking function and Adaptive
Brake Assist.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can
help you to minimise the risk of a collision
Z
Safety
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
73
Safety
74
Driving safety systems
with the vehicle in front or reduce the effects
of such a collision.
If COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
detects that there is a risk of a collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically. If you
do not react to the visual and audible collision
warning, autonomous braking can be initiated
in critical situations. If you apply the brake
yourself in a critical situation, the COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS Adaptive Brake
Assist assists you.
Important safety notes
Detection of hazardous situations can be particularly impaired by:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rnew vehicles or after a service on the COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS system
Observe the important safety notes in the
"Running-in notes" section (Y page 164).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rsnow
Activating/deactivating
The COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is
automatically active after switching on the
ignition.
You can activate or deactivate COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS in the on-board
computer (Y page 256). When deactivated,
the distance warning function and the autonomous braking function are also deactivated.
If COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is
deactivated, the æ symbol appears in the
assistance graphics display.
Distance warning function
General notes
The distance warning function can help you to
minimise the risk of a collision with the vehicle in front or reduce the effects of such a
collision. If the distance warning function
detects that there is a risk of a collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 72).
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation; do not rely on the distance warning
function alone.
Rnot
Function
The distance warning function issues a warning at speeds:
Vehicles without DISTRONIC PLUS: the
autonomous braking function is available in
the following speed ranges:
Rof approximately 30 km/h or more, if, over
R7
several seconds, the distance maintained
to the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient. The · distance warning lamp
then lights up in the instrument cluster.
Rof approximately 7 km/h or more, if you
rapidly approach a vehicle in front. An intermittent warning tone will then sound, and
the · distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause the system to display a
warning.
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h, the
distance warning function can also react to
stationary obstacles, such as stopped or
parked vehicles.
Autonomous braking function
If the driver does not react to the distance
warning signal in a critical situation, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can assist
with the autonomous braking function.
The autonomous braking function:
Rgives
the driver more time to react to critical driving situations
Rcan help the driver to avoid an accident or
Rreduces the effects of an accident
- 105 km/h for moving objects
- 50 km/h for stationary objects
Vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: the autonomous braking function is available in the following speed ranges:
R7
R7
- 200 km/h for moving objects
- 50 km/h for stationary objects
Due to the nature of the system, complicated
but non-critical driving conditions may also
cause the Autonomous Braking function to
intervene.
If the autonomous braking function demands
particularly high braking force, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated simultaneously (Y page 58).
R7
Adaptive Brake Assist
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
With the help of Adaptive Brake Assist, the
distance warning signal can detect obstacles
that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
If Adaptive Brake Assist detects a risk of collision with the vehicle in front, it calculates
the braking force necessary to avoid a collision. If you apply the brakes forcefully, Adaptive Brake Assist will automatically increase
the braking force to a level suitable for the
traffic conditions.
Adaptive Brake Assist provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds
above 7 km/h. It uses radar sensor technology to assess the traffic situation.
Up to a speed of approximately 250 km/h,
Adaptive Brake Assist is capable of reacting
to moving objects that have already been
detected as such at least once over the period
of observation.
Z
75
Safety
Driving safety systems
Safety
76
Driving safety systems
Up to a speed of approximately 70 km/h,
Adaptive Brake Assist reacts to stationary
obstacles.
If Adaptive Brake Assist demands particularly
high braking force, preventative passenger
protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously (Y page 58).
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
Rthere is no longer any danger of a collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Adaptive Brake Assist is then deactivated.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 72).
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist can:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, the Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause Brake Assist to intervene.
If Adaptive Brake Assist is not available due to
a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system remains available with full
brake boosting effect and BAS.
Adaptive brake lights
The adaptive brake lights warn following traffic in an emergency braking situation:
Rby
flashing brake lamps
hazard warning lamps are activated
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In
this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 129).
Rthe
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tyres
and the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
Only use wheels with the recommended tyre
sizes. Only then will ESP® function properly.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
Characteristics of ESP®
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
General notes
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
tion (Y page 72).
ETS traction control is part of ESP®. On vehicles with 4MATIC, 4ETS is a component of
ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles without 4MATIC: when towing
away your vehicle with the front axle raised,
please observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 364).
If the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
continuously, ESP® is deactivated.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp and the å
warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 306) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 266).
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP®
was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
You can select between the following statuses of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Z
77
Safety
Driving safety systems
78
Driving safety systems
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
You can select between the following statuses of ESP®:
Rin
Safety
Deactivating/activating ESP®
(Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
You can deactivate or activate ESP® via the
on-board computer (Y page 256).
ESP® deactivated:
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
ESP® activated:
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
RTraction control is still activated
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST is no longer available; nor is it activated if you brake
firmly with assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; it is also
not activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly
REngine
RESP®
is activated
handling mode is activated
®
RESP is deactivated
ESP® is activated every time the engine is
switched on, regardless of whether ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was switched
off.
RSPORT
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
In the following situations, it may be better to
activate SPORT handling mode or deactivate
ESP®:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the
vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics are desired
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires an extremely qualified and
experienced driver.
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
Driving safety systems
Deactivating/activating ESP®
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree
RTraction control is still activated
REngine torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
To activate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up. The
SPORT handling mode message appears
in the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
X
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
in the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷
ESP® ON message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Characteristics of activated SPORT handling mode
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
RTraction control is still activated
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST is no longer available; nor is it activated if you brake
firmly with assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; it is also
not activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly
REngine
ESP® trailer stabilisation
General notes
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, ESP® assists you in this situation. ESP®
slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting the engine output until the vehicle/trailer
combination has stabilised.
Z
Safety
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
79
80
Protection against theft
Important safety notes
Safety
G WARNING
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can
tip over before ESP® can detect this. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, you can only stabilise the vehicle/
trailer combination by depressing the brake
firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation is active above
speeds of approximately 65 km/h.
ESP® trailer stabilisation does not work if
ESP® is deactivated or disabled because of a
malfunction.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 211) and
hill start assist (Y page 169).
STEER CONTROL
General notes
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering
wheel in the direction required for vehicle
stabilisation.
This steering support is provided in particular
if:
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake
Rthe vehicle starts to skid
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if:
Important safety notes
Rthe
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 72).
G WARNING
If EBD is malfunctioning, the rear wheels can
lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the
risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 304) as well as display messages (Y page 268).
RESP®
is malfunctioning
steering is faulty
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electrical power steering.
Protection against theft
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
Protection against theft
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid key has been left
inside the vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
X
or
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/
Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 165).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is deactivated.
X
X
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
To switch the alarm off with the key:
press the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is deactivated.
To deactivate the alarm using KEYLESSGO: grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is deactivated.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is deactivated.
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
i If the alarm stays on for more than
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe tailgate
Rthe bonnet
Rthe
30 seconds, the Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system automatically sends a
message to the Customer Assistance
Centre. This is done by means of a text
message or a data connection.
The emergency call system sends a message or establishes a data connection provided that:
Ryou
have subscribed to the
Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system
Rthe Mercedes‑Benz emergency call system has been activated properly
Rthe necessary mobile phone network is
available
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
Z
Safety
To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS-GO: switch the ignition
off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
81
Protection against theft
82
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
Safety
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe tailgate is closed
Only then is tow-away protection primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 60 seconds.
X
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again
door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate tow-away
protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ra
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Ris
Switching off
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Activating
Make sure that:
side windows are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthe tailgate is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Rthe
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS-GO: switch off the engine
using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
X
Protection against theft
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button.
The key must be in the vehicle.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
switched off.
Deactivating
X
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof remains open
Rthe
side windows remain open
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double-lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has
been locked with the key (Y page 93).
Deactivate the interior motion sensor
before you lock the vehicle with the key.
The doors can then be opened from the
inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside with the key. Observe the
"Important safety notes" (Y page 93).
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
or
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function or KEYLESS-GO: switch off the engine
using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes several times in
rapid succession.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
X
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again and
door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
Ra
Z
Safety
Switching off
83
84
85
Useful information .............................. 86
Key ........................................................ 86
Doors .................................................... 93
Luggage compartment ....................... 96
Side windows .................................... 101
Opening and closing
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 105
86
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Do not keep the key:
Rwith
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start function:
do not keep the key in the luggage compartment. Otherwise, the key may not be detected, e.g. when starting the engine using the
Start/Stop button.
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 83).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. You can open the rear doors from
inside the vehicle if they are not secured by
the child-proof locks (Y page 71). The antitheft alarm system is triggered if the door is
Key
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
Key functions
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated or deactivated using
the on-board computer (Y page 260).
X To open the tailgate automatically from
outside the vehicle: press and hold button
F until the tailgate opens (Y page 98).
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESSGO start function:
X To close the tailgate automatically from
outside the vehicle: if the key is located in
the immediate vicinity of the vehicle, press
the F button on the key (Y page 98).
When the tailgate closes you can then
release the button.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
: & Locks the vehicle
; F Opens the tailgate
= % Unlocks the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press the % button.
If you do not open the vehicle within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
vehicle locks again
against theft is reactivated
Rprotection
X
To lock: press the & button.
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
tailgate
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
When the locator lighting is activated in Audio
20/COMAND Online, it lights up when it is
dark after the vehicle is unlocked with the
remote control (see separate operating
instructions).
Rthe
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key
in the vehicle.
Locking and unlocking
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you need to carry
the key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO functions with the functions of a
conventional key. Unlock the vehicle by using
KEYLESS-GO, for instance, and lock it using
the & button on the key.
The driver's door and the door at which the
handle is used must both be closed. The key
must be outside the vehicle. When locking or
unlocking with KEYLESS-GO, the distance
between the key and the corresponding door
handle must not be greater than 1 m.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example:
Rwhen
starting the engine
Rwhilst driving
Z
Opening and closing
opened from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 81).
87
Key
88
the external door handles are
touched
Rduring convenience closing
Opening and closing
Rwhen
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface : or ;.
Make sure that you do not touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period.
For further information on the convenience
closing feature (Y page 103).
X
the purposes of activation or deactivation,
the vehicle does not have to be nearby.
X To deactivate: press the & button on
the key twice in rapid succession.
The battery check lamp of the key flashes
twice briefly and lights up once, then KEYLESS-GO is deactivated (Y page 90).
X To activate: press any button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
KEYLESS-GO and all of its associated features are available again.
KEYLESS-GO start function
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a key
in the vehicle.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means that only the driver's door
and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the
vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel alone.
To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons simultaneously for about six seconds until the battery indicator lamp flashes twice
(Y page 90).
If the setting of the locking system is changed
within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
X
X
To unlock the tailgate: pull tailgate handle :.
Deactivating and activating
If you do not intend to use the vehicle for an
extended period of time, you can deactivate
KEYLESS-GO. The key will then use very little
power, thereby conserving battery power. For
Rlocks
or
Runlocks the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock: press the % button once.
To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
X
Key
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
X
To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 90).
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the tailgate, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 81).
There are several ways to deactivate the
alarm:
X
To deactivate the alarm with the key:
press the % or & button on the key.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X
Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X
To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
Removing the emergency key element
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and, at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
Further information about:
X
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 95)
the luggage compartment
(Y page 100)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 96)
Runlocking
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely into the key until it engages and
release catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
Z
Opening and closing
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
89
Key
90
Opening and closing
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the battery replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Checking the battery
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 90).
i If the key battery is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 89).
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens.
When doing so, do not hold cover : shut.
X Remove battery tray cover :.
X
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X Insert the front tabs of battery tray cover :
and then press to close it.
X Insert emergency key element into the key
(Y page 89).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
91
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function: try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's
door handle from close range and press the % or & button.
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery (Y page 90) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 90).
X Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function: try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's
door handle from close range and press the % or & button.
X
If this does not work:
X Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
X Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can no longer lock The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
or unlock the vehicle
X Check the key battery (Y page 90) and replace it if necessary
using KEYLESS-GO.
(Y page 90).
If this does not work:
X Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
Z
Opening and closing
Problems with the key
92
Key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Opening and closing
X
If the vehicle can also not be locked/unlocked using the remote
control function:
X Lock (Y page 95) or unlock (Y page 96) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
the on-board voltage is too low
X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 359).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 360).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
The vehicle is locked.
started using the Start/ X Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
Stop button. The key is
in the vehicle.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Check the key battery (Y page 90) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 90).
If this does not work:
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
X
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You have lost a key.
X
93
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the luggage compartment. Observe the loading
guidelines (Y page 316).
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked with the key,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate
the double lock function by deactivating the
interior motion sensor (Y page 83). The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside. You
can open the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not secured by the child-proof
locks (Y page 71). The anti-theft alarm system
is triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm (Y page 81).
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
! The side windows will not open/close if
the battery is discharged or if the side windows have iced up. It will then not be possible to close the door. Do not attempt to
force the door to close. You could otherwise damage the door or the side window.
When a door is opened, the side window on
that side opens slightly. When the door is
closed, the side window is raised again.
Z
Opening and closing
X
Doors
94
Opening and closing
outside. You can open the rear doors from
inside the vehicle if they are not secured by
the child-proof locks (Y page 71). The antitheft alarm system is triggered if the door is
opened from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 81).
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and opens.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked. You can only open
the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they
are not secured by the child-proof locks
(Y page 71).
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key from the outside, opening a door from
the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 81).
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 83).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. This can be useful if you wish
to lock the vehicle before pulling away, for
example.
To unlock: press button :.
X To lock: press button ;.
If all the doors and the tailgate are closed,
the vehicle locks.
X
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key from the outside, opening a door from
the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 81).
You can open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the childproof locks (Y page 71).
Doors
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will
be observed if the vehicle has been:
Automatic locking feature
Rlocked
Rlocked
with the locking button for the central locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door
which has been opened from the inside is
unlocked if only the driver's door had been
previously unlocked.
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X
If you press one of the two buttons and do not
hear a tone, the relevant setting has already
been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed
vehicle is being towed
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer
You can also activate and deactivate the automatic locking function using the on-board
computer (Y page 260).
Rthe
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 81).
Z
Opening and closing
with the locking button for the central locking or
Rlocked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. Only the door
which has been opened from the inside is
unlocked if only the driver's door had been
previously unlocked.
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock
function by deactivating the interior motion
sensor (Y page 83). The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open
the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they
are not secured by the child-proof locks
(Y page 71). The anti-theft alarm system is
triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm (Y page 81).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will
be observed if the vehicle has been:
95
Luggage compartment
Opening and closing
96
X
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 89).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 89).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
The door is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 89).
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the tailgate
are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 89).
X
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key
element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the tailgate.
X Press the locking button on the driver’s
door (Y page 94).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press the locking knobs
down by hand if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X
X
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
the fuel filler flap is not locked. The antitheft alarm system is not primed.
Luggage compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Luggage compartment
Rpress
the F button on the key.
Rpull or press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
Rpress the close button or STOP button on
the tailgate.
Rpull the handle on the tailgate.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. If the tailgate
is open when the engine is running, particularly if the vehicle is moving, exhaust fumes
could enter the passenger compartment.
There is a risk of poisoning.
Turn off the engine before opening the tailgate. Never drive with the tailgate open.
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
The opening dimensions of the tailgate can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 410).
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the luggage compartment. Observe the loading
guidelines (Y page 316).
Do not leave the key in the luggage compartment. You could otherwise lock yourself out.
The tailgate can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
with EASY-PACK tailgate:
opened/closed automatically from the outside
Rvehicles with EASY-PACK tailgate:
opened/closed automatically from the
inside
Rvehicles with EASY-PACK tailgate and
KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function: closed with the remote operating
switch on the key
Remergency release activated from the
inside
Rvehicles
Tailgate obstruction detection with
reversing function
On vehicles with EASY-PACK tailgate, the tailgate is equipped with automatic obstacle recognition with a reversing feature. If a solid
object blocks or restricts the tailgate when
automatically opening or closing, the tailgate
is stopped. If the tailgate is stopped during
the closing process, the tailgate automatically opens again slightly. The automatic
obstacle recognition with reversing function
is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your
attentiveness when opening and closing the
tailgate.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 8 mm of the closing path
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
Z
Opening and closing
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
97
Luggage compartment
98
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
the F button on the key or
or press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door or
Rpress the closing button/STOP button in
the tailgate or
Rpull the handle on the tailgate
Opening and closing
Rpull
Opening and closing manually
Opening
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
Rpress
the F button on the key.
or press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
Rpress the close button or STOP button on
the tailgate.
Rpull the handle on the tailgate.
Rpull
Press the % button on the key.
X Pull handle :.
X Raise the tailgate.
X
Closing
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
Two warning tones sound while the tailgate is
opening or closing.
The opening dimensions of the tailgate can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 410).
Opening automatically
Pull the tailgate down using handle :.
Let the tailgate to drop into the lock.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO.
X
X
You can open the tailgate automatically with
the key or the handle in the tailgate.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the tailgate opens.
or
X When the tailgate is unlocked, pull the handle and let it go again immediately.
Luggage compartment
Closing automatically
or
Vehicles with the EASY-PACK tailgate: you
can also close the tailgate automatically from
outside the vehicle.
X
99
Press or pull the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
Important safety notes
Example: vehicles with KEYLESS-GO
X
To close: press button : on the tailgate.
or
X
Vehicles with EASY-PACK tailgate and
KEYLESS-GO or KEYLESS-GO start function: if the key is located in the immediate
vicinity of the vehicle, press the F button on the key.
You can release the button as soon as the
tailgate starts to close.
Vehicles with EASY-PACK tailgate and
KEYLESS-GO: when the driver's door is
closed you can simultaneously close the tailgate and lock the vehicle. The KEYLESS-GO
key must be in the rear detection range of the
vehicle.
X
To close the tailgate and lock the vehicle: press locking button ; on the tailgate.
If KEYLESS-GO detects a key outside the
vehicle within the rear detection range, the
tailgate closes.
The vehicle is locked.
X
To stop the closing process: press button : on the tailgate again.
or
X
Pull the handle in the tailgate.
or
X
Press the F button on the key until the
tailgate stops.
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
Rpress
the F button on the key
or press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
tailgate
Rpull the handle on the tailgate
Rpull
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
Two warning tones sound while the tailgate is
opening or closing.
The opening dimensions of the tailgate can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 410).
Opening and closing automatically
You can open the tailgate from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary and
unlocked.
It is only possible to close the tailgate from
the driver's seat on vehicles with the EASYPACK tailgate.
Z
Opening and closing
Opening and closing automatically
from the inside
Luggage compartment
100
Rpress the closing button in the tailgate, or
Opening and closing
Rpull
the handle on the outside of the tailgate again or
Rpress the tailgate button on the key.
X To store the position: press and hold the
closing button in the tailgate until two short
tones sound.
The opening angle limiter is activated. The
tailgate then stops in the stored position
when opened.
To open: pull remote operating switch for
the tailgate : until the tailgate opens.
X To close: turn the key to position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock (Y page 165).
X Press and hold the remote operating switch
for tailgate : until the tailgate is completely closed.
X
Deactivating
X
Press and hold the closing button in the
tailgate until you hear a short tone.
Emergency release
General notes
Limiting the opening angle of the tailgate
General notes
! Make sure there is sufficient clearance to
open the tailgate fully when setting the
opening angle. The tailgate could otherwise
be damaged. Ideally, set the opening angle
outside.
You can limit the opening angle of the tailgate. This could be useful, for example, if
there is insufficient space above the tailgate.
It is possible to limit the tailgate in the top half
of its opening range.
To open the tailgate fully, pull the handle on
the outside of the tailgate again after it has
stopped automatically. This does not delete
the stored position.
Priming
To open the tailgate: pull the handle on
the tailgate.
X To stop the opening procedure at the
desired position:
X
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
The opening dimensions of the tailgate can be
found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 410).
If the tailgate can no longer be unlocked:
Rusing
the key, or
the remote operating switch in the
door control panel:
Use the emergency release on the inside of
the tailgate.
You can reach the emergency release via the
luggage compartment.
Rusing
Side windows
Opening
101
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
Remove the luggage compartment cover
(Y page 322).
X Fold rear seat backrest forwards
(Y page 320).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 89).
X Insert emergency key element ; into
opening : in the trim and push it in.
X Open the tailgate.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 89).
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the key with you and lock the vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
X
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
Side window reversing feature
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts a side window from travelling upwards during the automatic closing
process, the side window opens again automatically. During the manual closing process,
the side window only opens again automatically after the corresponding switch is
released. The automatic reversing feature is
only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing a side window.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rwhile
resetting
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing, make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
Side windows
102
active for five minutes or until the driver's
or front-passenger door is opened.
Opening and closing
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
i The side windows cannot be operated
from the rear when the override feature for
the side windows is activated (Y page 72).
Convenience opening feature
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, the KEYLESSGO start function, Exclusive Package or
AMG Exclusive Package: you can ventilate
the vehicle before you start driving.
The key can also be used to carry out the following functions simultaneously:
Runlock
the vehicle
the side windows
Ropen the panorama sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblind
The convenience opening feature can only be
operated using the key.
The "convenience opening" feature is also
available when the vehicle is unlocked.
X Vehicles with Exclusive Package or
AMG Exclusive Package but without
KEYLESS-GO and the KEYLESS-GO start
function: for the following operations,
point the tip of the key at the door handle
on the driver's door. The key must be close
to the driver's door handle.
i Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: the key must be
in close proximity to the vehicle.
Ropen
:
;
=
?
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation:
press/pull the corresponding switch again.
i If you press/pull the switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
X
i You can continue to operate the side windows after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the panorama sunroof
are in the desired position.
If the roller sunblind of the panorama sliding sunroof is closed, the roller sunblind is
opened first.
X Press and hold the % button once more
until the panorama sliding sunroof reaches
the desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, the KEYLESSGO start function, Exclusive Package or
AMG Exclusive Package: at the same time
you can:
Rlock
the vehicle
the side windows
Rclose the panorama sliding sunroof
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof,
you can then close the roller sunblind.
Rclose
Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the panorama sliding
sunroof are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X
Press and hold the & button again until
the roller sunblind of the panorama sliding
sunroof closes.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The driver's door and the door at which the
handle is used must both be closed. The key
must be outside the vehicle. The gap between
the key and the corresponding door handle
should not be greater than 1 m.
i Notes on the automatic reversing feature
for:
Rthe
side windows (Y page 101)
panorama sliding sunroof
(Y page 106)
Rthe roller sunblind (Y page 108)
Rthe
Using the key
Vehicles with Exclusive Package or
AMG Exclusive Package but without
KEYLESS-GO and the KEYLESS-GO start
function: for the following operations,
point the tip of the key at the door handle
on the driver's door. The key must be close
to the driver's door handle.
i Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the KEYLESS-GO start function: the key must be
in close proximity to the vehicle.
X
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor surface :.
X
Make sure that all the side windows are
closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle again until the roller sunblind
of the panorama sliding sunroof closes.
Z
Opening and closing
Convenience closing feature
103
Side windows
104
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
Opening and closing
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 102).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 102).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly. If
this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
X
Panorama sliding sunroof
105
Problems with the side windows
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Panorama sliding sunroof
If somebody becomes trapped:
Important safety notes
Rrelease
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
While opening and closing the sliding sunroof,
body parts in close proximity could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the opening and closing procedures.
the switch immediately, or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening or closing procedure will be stopped.
Rduring
G WARNING
If children operate the sliding sunroof they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
Opening and closing
106
Panorama sliding sunroof
G WARNING
At high speeds the raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers slightly at the rear. This could
trap you or other persons. There is a risk of
injury. Make sure that nobody reaches into
the sweep of the sliding sunroof whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
If somebody becomes trapped, immediately
pull back the sliding sunroof switch. The sliding sunroof lifts during opening.
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
automatic opening/closing process
The closing process is stopped.
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof if
it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
Operating the panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
i Resonance noises can occur in addition to
the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
Reversing function of the sliding sunroof
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
The sliding sunroof is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the sliding sunroof during the closing
process, the sliding sunroof opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing feature is, however, only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing the sliding roof.
G WARNING
The reversing feature does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rwhile
resetting
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
The panorama sliding sunroof can only be
operated when the roller sunblind is open.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
After opening the sliding sunroof, the roller
sunblind automatically closes slightly. This
reduces drafts in the vehicle interior.
Panorama sliding sunroof
Rain-closing feature when the engine is
switched off
The rain-closing feature is only available for
vehicles with a rain sensor.
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the panorama sliding sunroof closes automatically:
Rif
it starts to rain
Rat extreme outside temperatures
Rafter six hours
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply
The panorama sliding sunroof remains raised
at the rear in order to allow ventilation of the
vehicle interior.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed
when being closed by the rain-closing feature,
it opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is then deactivated.
The panorama sliding sunroof does not close
if:
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor.
If, for example, the vehicle is under a bridge
or in a carport, the field of the sensor may
be covered.
Rit
Rain-closing feature when driving
The raised panorama sliding sunroof automatically lowers when driving if it starts to
rain. The sliding sunroof is lowered depending
on:
Rthe
road speed and
intensity of the rain
You can manually cancel the automatic closing procedure. Press or pull the 3 switch
in any direction.
To raise the panorama sliding sunroof again,
press the 3 button in direction :. The
rain-closing feature remains activated.
Rthe
Operating the roller sunblind for the
panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped
between the roller sunblind and frame or sliding sunroof during automatic opening or closing. There is a risk of injury.
When opening or closing, make sure that no
body parts are in the sweep of the roller sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
automatic opening/closing process
The opening/closing process is stopped.
Z
Opening and closing
If the sliding sunroof is raised at the rear, it
automatically lowers slightly at higher
speeds. The noise level in the vehicle interior
is reduced as a result.
At low speeds it raises again automatically.
You can also temporarily deactivate automatic lowering. To do so, press the 3
switch. The sliding sunroof raises again automatically.
You can continue to operate the sliding sunroof after switching off the engine or removing the key. This function remains active for
five minutes or until you open a front door.
The sliding sunroof cannot be opened if a roof
carrier is fitted. In order to allow ventilation of
the vehicle interior, you can raise the sliding
sunroof.
If contact is made with a roof carrier approved
by Mercedes-Benz, the sliding sunroof lowers
slightly but remains raised at the rear.
107
108
Panorama sliding sunroof
The roller sunblind shields the vehicle interior
from sunlight. The roller sunblind can only be
opened and closed when the panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
Opening and closing
Opening and closing
Roller sunblind reversing feature
The roller sunblind is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the roller sunblind during the closing
process, the roller sunblind opens again automatically. The automatic reversing feature is,
however, only an aid and is no substitute for
your attention when closing the roller sunblind.
G WARNING
The reversing feature does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rwhen closing the roller sunblind again man-
ually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing the roller sunblind, make sure
that no body parts are in the sweep.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
Rpress the switch in any direction during the
automatic closing process
The closing process is stopped.
: To open
; To open
= To close
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
X
If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
After opening the panorama sliding sunroof,
the roller sunblind automatically closes
slightly. This reduces drafts in the vehicle
interior.
Resetting the panorama sliding sunroof
or the roller sunblind
Reset the panorama sliding sunroof or the
roller sunblind if the panorama sliding sunroof
Panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
or the roller sunblind does not move
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow :
until the panorama sliding sunroof is fully
closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow :
until the roller sunblind is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Make sure that the panorama sliding sunroof and the roller sunblind can be fully
opened and closed again.
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
109
Z
110
Panorama sliding sunroof
Problems with the panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
G WARNING
If you do not reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption, then the
reversing function will malfunction or not work. The sliding sunroof closes with increased or
maximum force. Parts of the body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses
an increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
In such or similar situations always make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
Always reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The panorama sliding
sunroof cannot be
closed and you cannot
see the cause.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to
the point of resistance until the panorama sliding sunroof is
closed.
The panorama sliding sunroof is closed with more force.
If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing
and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after it blocks, pull the 3 switch down again to
the point of resistance until the panorama sliding sunroof is
closed.
The panorama sliding sunroof is closed without the automatic
reversing feature.
111
Useful information ............................ 112
Correct driver's seat position .......... 112
Seats .................................................. 113
Steering wheel .................................. 118
Mirrors ............................................... 119
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory function ............................... 122
112
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Observe the safety notes on seat adjustment (Y page 113).
X Make sure that seat = is correctly adjusted.
Manual seat adjustment (Y page 114)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 115)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
X
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's airbag as possible
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly
Ryou have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported
Ryou can depress the pedals properly
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted correctly (Y page 115).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety notes on steering column adjustment (Y page 118).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted correctly.
Adjusts the steering wheel (Y page 118)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 44).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 46).
Ryou
Seats
Rfit
snugly across your body
Rbe routed across the middle of your
shoulder
Rbe routed across your hips in the pelvic
area
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 119)
so that you have a good view of road and
traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat and exterior mirror settings
(Y page 122).
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no key in the ignition lock.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
Observe the safety notes on "Airbags"
(Y page 48) and "Children in the Vehicle"
(Y page 59).
G WARNING
If the driver's seat is not correctly engaged, it
could unexpectedly move while driving. This
could cause you to lose control of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always ensure that the driver's seat is
engaged before starting the vehicle.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat belt should:
113
Seats
114
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
Seat height:
X
Pull handle ; upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Vehicles with the seating comfort package
i Further related subjects:
RLuggage
compartment enlargement
(folding down the rear seats)
(Y page 319)
Adjusting the seats manually
Vehicles without the seating comfort
package
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment:
Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards
or rearwards.
X Release lever : again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
X
Backrest angle:
X
X
Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
Turn handwheel A forwards or backwards.
Seat height:
X
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment:
Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards
or backwards.
X Release lever : again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
X
Backrest angle:
Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
X Turn handwheel = forwards or backwards.
X
Pull handle ? upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Seat cushion angle:
Adjust the angle so that your thighs have
gentle support.
X Turn handwheel = forwards or backwards.
X
Seat cushion length:
Lift handle ; and slide the front part of the
seat cushion forwards or backwards.
X Release lever ; again.
The seat cushion engages.
X
Seats
Adjusting the seats electrically
115
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so that it is as close as possible to the
back of your head.
General notes
Adjusting the head restraints manually
:
;
=
?
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Backrest angle
Adjusting the head restraint height
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 122).
Adjusting the head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the head restraint fore-and-aft
position
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
For vehicles with sports seats you cannot
adjust the front head restraints or the outer
rear head restraints.
Seats
116
This function allows you to adjust the distance between the head restraint and the
back of the head.
To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards in the direction of the arrow until
it engages.
There are a number of detents.
X To move backwards: press and hold
release button : and push the head
restraint backwards.
X When the head restraint is in the desired
position, release the button and make sure
that the head restraint is engaged in position.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
Fold the seat backrest slightly forwards in
order to remove the head restraint
(Y page 320).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired height.
X To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
X
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
The rear head restraints on the outer seats
can be removed and refitted. For vehicles
with sports seats the rear head restraints
cannot be removed and refitted.
:
;
=
?
Raises the backrest contour
Softens the backrest contour
Lowers the backrest contour
Hardens the backrest contour
Seats
117
AMG Performance Seat
Adjusting the side bolsters of the seat
cushion
To set the side bolsters of the seat
cushion narrower: press button :.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat
cushion wider: press button ;.
X
Adjusting the seat backrest side bolsters
To set the side bolsters of the seat
backrest narrower: press button =.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat
backrest wider: press button ?.
X
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after approximately
eight minutes.
The system automatically switches from level
2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
X
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Vehicles with electrically adjustable seats: to
adjust the contour of the seat and for
improved lateral support, you can individually
adjust the front seats.
118
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
switched off prematurely or cannot be
switched on.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating will
switch back on automatically.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Adjusting the steering wheel
G WARNING
The steering wheel may move unexpectedly if
you adjust it while driving. This could cause
you to lose control of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Make sure that the steering wheel is locked
before driving off. Never unlock the steering
wheel when the vehicle is in motion.
: Release lever
; Adjusts the steering wheel height
= Adjusts the steering wheel position (fore-
and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up as far as it will go.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Mirrors
119
Mirrors
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, or to
the left or right until you have adjusted the
exterior mirror to the correct position. You
should have a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: pivot anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior mirrors are automatically heated at low
outside temperatures. Heating takes a maximum of ten minutes.
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Mirrors
120
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
i If you are driving faster than 47 km/h, you
can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 261).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Briefly press button :.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 261):
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position (forwards or backwards), proceed as
follows:
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: manually move the exterior mirror into the correct position.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold the mirrorfolding button (Y page 120) until you hear a
click and the mirror audibly engages into
position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 119).
X
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G WARNING
Electrolyte may escape if the glass of an automatic anti-dazzle mirror breaks. Electrolyte is
harmful and causes irritation. It must not
come into contact with your skin, eyes, respiratory organs or clothing or be swallowed.
There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with electrolyte,
observe the following:
Rimmediately
rinse off electrolyte from your
skin with water.
Rimmediately and thoroughly rinse electrolyte out of eyes using clean water.
Mirrors
electrolyte is swallowed, immediately
rinse out your mouth thoroughly. Do not
induce vomiting.
Rif electrolyte comes into contact with skin
or eyes or is swallowed, seek medical attention immediately.
Rimmediately change out of clothing that has
been in contact with electrolyte.
Rif an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
The "Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors" function
is only available if the vehicle is equipped with
the "Mirror package".
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged or if the interior lighting is switched on.
Rincident
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
General notes
The "Parking position for the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side" function is only
available if the vehicle is equipped with the
"Memory package".
Using reverse gear
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the kerb in the exterior mirror.
The parking position is stored.
X
X
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
Setting and storing the parking position
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
Using the memory button
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M ?.
X
X
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rif
121
Memory function
122
Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the kerb in the exterior mirror.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Calling up a stored parking position
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side with the corresponding button (Y page 119).
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
X
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side.
Memory function
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the memory function adjusts the seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any part of
their body within the sweep of the seat. If
someone becomes trapped, immediately
release the memory function position button.
The adjustment is stopped.
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
The memory function can be used at any time,
e.g. even when the key is not in the ignition
lock.
Storing settings
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rseat and backrest position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Memory function
123
Adjust the seat (Y page 115).
Adjust the exterior mirror on the driver's
side (Y page 119).
X Briefly press the M memory button and
then press preset position button 1, 2 or 3
within three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press and hold the relevant preset position
button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat and exterior
mirrors are in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
Z
124
125
Useful information ............................ 126
Exterior lighting ................................ 126
Interior lighting ................................. 132
Replacing bulbs ................................. 133
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers ........................... 137
126
Exterior lighting
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 25).
Exterior lighting
General notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
General notes
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (only vehicles
with Intelligent Light System). This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
Vehicles with bi-xenon or halogen headlamps
It is not necessary to switch your headlamps
to symmetrical dipped beam when driving in
countries where vehicles are driven on the
opposite side of the road to the country in
which the vehicle is registered. Legal require-
ments are fulfilled without switching the
headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam.
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System
Before crossing the border, set the headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam and after
returning back to asymmetrical dipped beam
via the "Dipped-beam headlamps for driving
on the right/left" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 259).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
"extended range foglamps" functions are not
available.
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set using the:
Rlight
switch
Rcombination
switch (Y page 129)
range adjustment (only vehicles
with halogen headlamps) (Y page 128)
Ron-board computer (Y page 259)
Rheadlamp
Light switch
Operation
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
Exterior lighting
led by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
C N Foglamp (vehicles with front fog-
lamps only)
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to the à position.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0 in the ignition lock.
Ropen
Automatic headlamp mode
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
Rkey
in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light
Rwith the engine running: depending on the
ambient light conditions, the daytime driving lights or the parking and dipped-beam
headlamps are switched on or off automatically
X To switch on the automatic headlamps:
turn the light switch to the à position.
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day.
When the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on, the green T (side
lamps) and L (dipped-beam headlamps)
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up.
Dipped-beam headlamps
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in the L position, the side lamps
and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped beam headlamps: turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Foglamps
In conditions where visibility is poor due to
fog, snow or rain, the foglamps improve visibility as well as making it easier for other road
users to see you. They can be operated
together with the side lamps or together with
the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps.
X To switch on the foglamps: turn the key
to position 2 in the ignition lock or start the
engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the foglamps: press the
N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Only vehicles with front foglamps are equipped with the "Foglamps" function; for how to
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
127
Exterior lighting
128
Lights and windscreen wipers
operate the foglamps on vehicles with the
Intelligent Light System (Y page 131).
Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of
your vehicle in heavy fog for the following
traffic. Please observe the country-specific
laws on the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key to position 2 in the ignition lock or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
i When the rear foglamp is switched on, the
centre brake lamp in the tail lamp switches
off due to a legal requirement.
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that
the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
To switch on the parking lamps: the key
should not be in the ignition lock or it
should be in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
X
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen
headlamps)
g Driver's seat and front-passenger seat
occupied
1 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied
2 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied, luggage compartment laden
3 Driver's and front-passenger seat occupied and maximum permissible rear axle
load utilised, e.g. when towing a trailer
The headlamp range control allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps to
suit the vehicle load.
X
X
Start the engine.
Turn the headlamp range control to the
position which corresponds to the load in
your vehicle.
Exterior lighting
Combination switch
Turn signals
129
Vehicles with Adaptive Highbeam Assist:
when Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active, it
controls activation and deactivation of the
main-beam headlamps (Y page 131).
Headlamp flasher
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2, or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
Headlamp cleaning system
Vehicles with bi-xenon headlamps: the headlamps are cleaned automatically if the "Wipe
with washer fluid" function is operated five
times while the lights are on and the engine is
running (Y page 137). When you switch off
the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning
system is reset and counting is resumed from
0.
Hazard warning lamps
Main-beam headlamps
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
130
Exterior lighting
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
Ran
airbag is deployed or
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 70 km/h and comes to a
standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
The hazard warning lamps continue to operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rthe
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
you are driving. This allows you to recognise
pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
Cornering light function
Intelligent Light System
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" function using the on-board
computer (Y page 259).
Active light function
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the
steering wheel.
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel.
The cornering light function may remain lit for
a short time, but is automatically switched off
after no more than three minutes.
Motorway mode
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
Exterior lighting
Active: if you are driving at a speed above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering
movements for at least 1,000 m or if you are
driving at a speed above 130 km/h.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
131
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
General notes
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp.
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp.
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it
switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Extended range foglamps
Interior lighting
132
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recognise
road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
recognises road users too late or not at all. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or activated regardless. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You
are responsible for adjusting the vehicle's
lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and
traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
Rdirt
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
on/off
X
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up when it is dark and the
light sensor switches on the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above 25 km/h:
The headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 30 km/h and no other road users
are recognised:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below 25 km/h
or other road users are recognised or the
roads are adequately lit:
The main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To deactivate: move the combination
switch back to its normal position.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display goes out.
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Certain climatic and physical conditions may
cause moisture to form in the headlamp. This
moisture does not affect the functionality of
the headlamp.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Front overhead control panel
: p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
; c Switches the front interior lighting
on
Replacing bulbs
on/off
? | Switches the front interior lighting/
automatic interior lighting control off
A p Switches the right-hand front reading lamp on/off
B Switches the automatic interior lighting
control on
Rear compartment control panel
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. This delayed switch-off can be
adjusted using COMAND Online or Audio 20
(see the separate operating instructions).
Ropen
Manual interior lighting control
To switch the front interior lighting on:
set the switch to the c position.
X To switch off the interior lighting: set the
switch to the | position or (if the door is
closed) to the centre position.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on or
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamp on or off:
press the p button.
X
: p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
; p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
Interior lighting control
General notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
The colour and brightness for the ambient
lighting may be set using COMAND Online or
Audio 20 (see the separate operating instructions).
Automatic interior lighting control
To switch on: set the switch to centre
position B.
X To switch off: set the switch to the |
position.
X
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X
To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X
Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs are under high voltage. You can
get an electric shock if you remove the cover
of the xenon bulb and touch the electrical
contacts. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
= v Switches the rear interior lighting
133
134
Replacing bulbs
Lights and windscreen wipers
Never touch the parts or the electrical contacts of the xenon bulb. Always have work on
the xenon bulbs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If your vehicle is equipped with xenon bulbs,
you can recognise this by the following: the
cone of light from the xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the engine. For this to be
observed, the lights must be switched on
before the engine is started.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
G WARNING
Bulbs, lamps and plug connectors can
become very hot during use. When replacing a
bulb, you could burn yourself on these components. There is a risk of injury.
Allow these components to cool down before
replacing the bulb.
There are bulbs other than the xenon bulbs
that you cannot replace yourself. Only replace
the bulbs listed (Y page 134). Have the bulbs
that you cannot replace yourself replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance replacing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can replace the following bulbs. The
details for the bulb type can be found in the
legend.
Do not use a bulb that has been dropped or if
its glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou
touch it
is hot
Ryou drop it
Ryou scratch it
Only operate bulbs in enclosed lamps
designed for that purpose. Only fit spare
bulbs of the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service
life of the bulbs. Do not touch the glass tube
with your bare hands. If necessary, clean the
glass tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and
rub it off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation. Do not allow bulbs to come into contact
with liquids.
Rit
Vehicles with halogen headlamps
: Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
; Main-beam headlamp/daytime driving
lamp/side lamp/parking lamp:
H15 55 W/15 W
= Dipped-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
Replacing bulbs
135
You must remove the cover of the front wheel
housing before you can change the front turn
signal lamp.
To remove: switch off the lights.
Turn the front wheels inwards.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is released.
X Push cover ; down.
X To fit: push cover ; up.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is locked.
X
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System
: Cornering lamp: H7 55 W
Dipped-beam headlamps (halogen
lamps)
Tail lamps (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
: Rear foglamp: P 21 W
; Brake lamp: W 16 W
= Brake lamp: W 16 W
? Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
A Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Replacing the front bulbs
Fitting/removing the cover on the front
wheel arch
Remove the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 135).
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; anticlockwise and pull
out.
X Pull the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; and turn it clockwise.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 135).
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Replacing bulbs
136
Lights and windscreen wipers
Main-beam headlamps/daytime driving
lights/side lamps and parking lamps
(vehicles with halogen headlamps)
Cornering light function (Intelligent
Light System)
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anticlockwise and
remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; anticlockwise and pull
out.
X Pull the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; and turn it clockwise.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X
Switch off the lights.
X Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anticlockwise and
remove it.
X Turn bulb ; anti-clockwise and remove it.
X Insert the new bulb and engage it to the
stop.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X
Turn signal lamp (halogen headlamps)
X
Replacing the rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
Switch off the lights.
X Open the bonnet.
X Turn bulb holder : anticlockwise and pull
out.
X Remove the bulb from bulb holder :.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder :.
X Insert bulb holder : and turn it clockwise
until it engages.
X
View of right-hand side trim panel
You must open the side trim panel in the luggage compartment before you can replace
the bulbs in the tail lamps.
Windscreen wipers
Tail lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the luggage compartment.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 136).
X
X
Brake lamp/rear foglamp/reversing
lamp: remove the corresponding bulb from
the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder.
X Turn signal: press the bulb gently into the
bulb holder, turn it anti-clockwise and
remove it from the bulb holder.
X
Insert the new bulb into bulb holder and
turn it clockwise.
X Reinsert the bulb holder and engage on
retaining clips :.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 136).
X
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
Press retaining clips : at the same time in
the direction of the arrows.
X Carefully remove the bulb holder together
with the connected plug and the bulbs.
X
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
Bulb holder
; Brake lamp
= Brake lamp
? Rear foglamp
A Reversing light
B Turn signals
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
To open: release right or left side trim
panel : at the top and fold it down in the
direction of the arrow.
X To close: insert side panel :.
X
137
Windscreen wipers
138
Lights and windscreen wipers
Switching the rear window wiper on/
off
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
3
4
5
B
set to low sensitivity)
Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
° Continuous wipe, slow
¯ Continuous wipe, fast
í Single wipe/î wipes the windscreen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the wind-
screen becomes dirty in dry weather conditions, the windscreen wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could damage the
windscreen wiper blades or scratch the
windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or
Å position, the appropriate wiping frequency is automatically set according to the
intensity of the rain. In the Å position, the
rain sensor is more sensitive than in the Ä
position, causing the windscreen wiper to
wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
mean you are unable to observe the traffic
conditions.
Combination switch
: è Switch
2 ô Wipes with washer fluid
3 I Switches on intermittent wiping
4 0 Switches off intermittent wiping
5 ô Wipes with washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Slide switch : on the combination switch
to the corresponding position.
When the rear window wiper is switched on,
the è symbol appears in the assistance
graphic in the instrument cluster. Further
information on the assistance graphic
(Y page 255).
X
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
Windscreen wipers
arm is folded away from the windscreen/
rear window.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen/
rear window.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the wiper arm without a wiper blade and it
falls onto the windscreen/rear window, the
windscreen/rear window may be damaged
by the force of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
(variant 1)
Removing the wiper blades
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: switch off
the engine.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
X
Fitting the wiper blades
Position new wiper blade : with recess B
on lug A.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = onto the wiper arm until retaining
clips ; engage in bracket ?.
X Make sure that wiper blade : is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
X
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
(variant 2)
Removing the wiper blades
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: switch off
the engine.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
Press both release clips ;.
Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = away from wiper arm ?.
X Remove wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow A.
X
X
X
Hold onto the wiper arm with one hand.
With the other hand, turn the wiper blade in
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
! Never open the bonnet/tailgate if a wiper
139
Windscreen wipers
140
Lights and windscreen wipers
the direction of arrow : away from the
wiper arm as far as it will go.
X Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the removal position with
a noticeable click.
X
Slide catch ; in the direction of arrow =
until it engages in the locking position with
a noticeable click.
X Make sure that the wiper blade is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
X
Remove the wiper blade in the direction of
arrow ? away from the wiper arm.
Fitting the wiper blades
X
Remove protective film : of the service
indicator on the tip of the wiper blade.
If the colour of the service indicator changes
from black to yellow, the wiper blades should
be replaced.
i The duration of the colour change varies
depending on the usage conditions.
Replacing the rear window wiper blade
Removing the wiper blades
X
Insert the new wiper blade into the wiper
arm in the direction of arrow :.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Fold wiper arm ? away from the rear window.
X Press both release clips ;.
X
X
Windscreen wipers
141
Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = away from wiper arm ?.
X Remove wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow A.
X
Lights and windscreen wipers
Fitting a wiper blade
Position new wiper blade : with recess B
on lug A.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = onto the wiper arm until retaining
clips ; engage in bracket ?.
X Make sure that wiper blade : is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the rear window.
X
Z
142
Windscreen wipers
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Lights and windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windscreen
are jammed.
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
fail completely.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The windscreen washer The spray nozzles are misaligned.
fluid from the spray
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist worknozzles no longer hits
shop.
the centre of the windscreen.
143
Useful information ............................ 144
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 144
Operating the climate control system ..................................................... 148
Climate control
Air vents ............................................ 161
144
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 25).
Overview of climate control systems
General notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch
off climate control only briefly
air-recirculation mode only briefly
Ractivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Ractivate the windscreen demisting function
briefly, if required
The air-conditioning system/
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
regulates the temperature and the humidity
of the vehicle interior and filters undesirable
substances from the air.
The air-conditioning system/
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
can only be operated when the engine is running. Optimum operation is only achieved
with the side windows and panorama sliding
sunroof closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 155).
Always keep the ventilation flaps behind the
side panelling clear (Y page 136). Otherwise
the vehicle will not be ventilated correctly.
Ractivate
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 102).
This will speed up the cooling process and
the desired interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and soot and completely filters out pollen. With THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control, gaseous pollutants
and odours will also be reduced. A clogged
filter reduces the amount of air supplied to
the vehicle interior. For this reason, you
should always observe the interval for
replacing the filter, which is specified in the
Service Booklet. As this depends on environmental conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be shorter than stated
in the Service Booklet.
i Vehicles with auxiliary heating: under
certain environmental conditions, the
residual heat function may be activated
automatically an hour after the key has
been removed in order to dry the automatic
climate control. When the automatic climate control drying function is active, the
blue LED lamp is lit in the rocker switch in
the centre console. The vehicle is then ventilated for 30 minutes.
Vehicles without auxiliary heating:
under certain environmental conditions,
the residual heat function may be activated
automatically an hour after the key has
been removed in order to dry the automatic
climate control. The vehicle is then ventilated for 30 minutes.
Overview of climate control systems
145
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
To set the temperature (Y page 150)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 152)
To set the air distribution (Y page 151)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 154)
To set the airflow (Y page 151)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 149)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 153)
Notes on using the air-conditioning
system
Air-conditioning system
Below, you can find a number of tips and recommendations for optimum use of the airconditioning system.
RSwitch on the air-conditioning system by
turning control knob A clockwise to the
desired position (except position 0).
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
RRecommendation for avoiding misted
windows at low exterior temperatures
or in rain: switch on the ¿ cooling with
dehumidification function (Y page 149).
Set air distribution to ¯ and if possible
switch off P and O (Y page 151).
Deactivate air-recirculation mode e
(Y page 154).
Set airflow control A to a setting between
3 and 6 (Y page 151).
RRecommendation for rapid cooling or
heating of the vehicle interior: briefly set
airflow control A to a setting between 3
and 6 (Y page 151).
RRecommendation for a constant vehicle interior temperature: set airflow control A to a setting between 1 and 3
(Y page 151).
RRecommendation for air distribution in
winter: select the O and ¯ settings
(Y page 151).
Recommendation for air distribution in
summer: select the P or P and
¯ settings (Y page 151).
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
Climate control
Control panel for air-conditioning system
146
Overview of climate control systems
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
Climate control
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RIf you change the settings of the climate
control system, the climate status display
appears for approximately three seconds
at the bottom of the screen in the Audio/
COMAND display (see separate operating
instructions). You will see the current settings of the various climate control functions.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
You can choose between various drive programs with the DYNAMIC SELECT button
(Y page 174).
If you have selected drive program E:
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster
is deactivated and in the warming-up phase
heat output is reduced
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
Depending on the configuration, the climate
settings can also be influenced in drive program I.
If you have selected drive program C or S, the
climate settings are not affected.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 171).
Overview of climate control systems
147
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
To set the temperature, left (Y page 150)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 150)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 152)
To increase the airflow (Y page 151)
To set the air distribution (Y page 151)
Display
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 154)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 148)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 150)
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 155)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 149)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 151)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 153)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 151)
Information on using THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the
à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" func-
tion briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes out.
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
148
Operating the climate control system
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
Climate control
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when
the ignition is switched off. The residual
heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off.
RIf you change the settings of the climate
control system, the climate status display
appears for approximately three seconds
at the bottom of the screen in the Audio/
COMAND display (see separate operating
instructions). You will see the current settings of the various climate control functions.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
You can choose between various drive programs with the DYNAMIC SELECT button
(Y page 174).
If you have selected drive program E:
Rwhen heating, the electrical heater booster
is deactivated and in the warming-up phase
heat output is reduced
Rthe rear window heating running time is
reduced
Depending on the configuration, the climate
settings can also be influenced in drive program I.
If you have selected drive program C or S, the
climate settings are not affected.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 171).
Operating the climate control system
Switching the climate control on/off
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could mist up.
Therefore, only switch off climate control
briefly.
Air-conditioning system
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To switch on: turn control A clockwise to
the desired position (except position 0)
(Y page 145).
X To switch off: turn control A anti-clockwise to position 0 (Y page 145).
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
i THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: switch on climate control primarily
using the à button.
Operating the climate control system
149
Activating/deactivating cooling with
air dehumidification
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only deactivate the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function briefly.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is only available when the engine is running. The air inside the vehicle is cooled and
dehumidified according to the temperature
selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
X
Climate control
General notes
Operating the climate control system
150
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in
The cooling with air dehumidification function has been deactivathe ¿ button
ted due to a malfunction.
flashes three times or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
remains off. The cooling with air dehumidification function cannot
be activated.
Climate control
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
Only THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control features the "Control climate control
automatically" function.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. If desired, cooling with
air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function briefly.
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
X
X
To switch to manual mode: press the
É or Ë button.
or
X
Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are deactivated.
Setting the temperature
Air-conditioning system
You can set the temperature for the entire
vehicle. The set temperature is automatically
maintained at a constant level.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To increase/reduce: turn control : anticlockwise or clockwise (Y page 145). Only
change the temperature setting in small
increments. Start at 22 †.
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides. The set
temperature is automatically maintained at a
constant level.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To increase/reduce: turn control : or E
anti-clockwise or clockwise (Y page 147).
X
Operating the climate control system
Setting the air distribution
Air-conditioning system
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister vents
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister vents, the centre and side air vents
as well as the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed if the adjusters are turned clockwise
until they engage.
i You can also activate several of the air
distribution settings simultaneously. In
order to do this, press several of the air
distribution buttons. The air is then routed
through different air vents.
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed if the adjusters are turned clockwise
until they engage.
Setting the air distribution
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press one or more of the P, O, ¯
buttons.
The corresponding indicator lamp comes
on.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
Setting the air distribution
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press the É or Ë button repeatedly
until the desired symbol appears in the display.
Setting the airflow
Air-conditioning system
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To increase/reduce: turn control A anticlockwise or clockwise (Y page 145).
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To increase/reduce: press the K or
I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
This function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
Climate control
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
151
Operating the climate control system
152
X
Climate control
X
To activate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
To deactivate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
Demisting the windscreen
General notes
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
i You should only select the "Windscreen
demisting" function until the windscreen is
clear again.
Switching the "Windscreen demisting"
function on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
i You can adjust the blower output man-
ually while the "Windscreen demisting"
function is in operation:
RAir-conditioning system: turn airflow
control A anti-clockwise or clockwise
(Y page 145).
RTHERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: press the ó or ô button.
X To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Air-conditioning system: turn temperature
control : anti-clockwise or clockwise
(Y page 145).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: turn temperature control : or E anticlockwise or clockwise (Y page 147).
X
Rhigh
airflow
temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
i The "Windscreen demisting" function
automatically sets the blower output to the
optimum demisting effect. As a result, the
airflow may increase or decrease automatically after the ¬ button is pressed.
Rhigh
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Air-conditioning system
Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Operating the climate control system
153
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
X Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
X Set the air distribution to P or O.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
Rear window heating
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
154
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot
be activated.
The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
lamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating can be activated again.
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off
Climate control
General notes
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you activate air-recirculation mode, the windows can mist up more quickly, in particular
at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
misting up.
The operation of air-recirculation mode is the
same for all control panels.
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X To activate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up.
X
Air-recirculation mode is activated automatically:
Rat
high outside temperatures
high levels of pollution
When air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically, the indicator lamp in the e
button is not lit. Outside air is added after
about 30 minutes.
X To deactivate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out.
Rat
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated
automatically:
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately
7†
Rafter approximately five minutes if the
"Cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
7 † if the cooling with air dehumidification function is activated
Convenience opening or closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, immediately press
Operating the climate control system
Convenience closing feature (vehicles
with panorama sliding sunroof): press
and hold the e button until the side
windows and the panorama sliding sunroof
are closed.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X Convenience closing feature (vehicles
without panorama sliding sunroof):
press and hold the e button until the
side windows are closed.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
Press the W button to stop the side windows.
The side windows stop.
X To then open the side window, press the
W button again.
or
X Press and hold the e button again for at
least two seconds.
The side windows move in the opposite
direction.
X Only vehicles with panorama sliding
sunroof: press the 3 switch to stop the
panorama sliding sunroof.
The panorama sliding sunroof stops.
X To then open the panorama sliding sunroof,
pull back on the 3 switch.
i Observe the notes on the automatic
reversing feature for:
X
Rthe
side windows (Y page 101)
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof
(Y page 106)
X Convenience opening feature (vehicles
with panorama sliding sunroof): press
and hold the e button until the side
windows and the panorama sliding sunroof
are open. The side windows and the panorama sliding sunroof move back to their
original position.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
X Convenience opening feature (vehicles
without panorama sliding sunroof):
press and hold the e button until the
side windows are open. The side windows
move back to their original positions.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows or the pan-
orama sliding sunroof manually after closing with the convenience closing feature,
they will remain in this position when
opened using the convenience opening feature.
Switching the residual heat on/off
General notes
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the vehicle
for approximately 30 minutes after the engine
has been switched off. The heating time
depends on the set interior temperature.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
i You cannot use the ventilation to cool the
vehicle interior to a temperature lower than
the outside temperature.
Z
Climate control
the W switch in the door to stop the movement of the side windows. To continue closing
the side window, pull on the W switch.
155
Operating the climate control system
156
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it (Y page 165).
X To activate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
X
i Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen the auxiliary heating is switched on
Climate control
Rwhen
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
The auxiliary heating and the exhaust gas outlet are situated in front of the right-hand front
wheel.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly once
a month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature. This
occurs without using the heat of the running
engine. The auxiliary heating is operated
directly using the vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the fuel tank must be at least Õ full to
ensure that the auxiliary heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
Operating the climate control system
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Set the desired temperature.
X
Auxiliary heating or ventilation can also be
switched on if the manually set climate control is activated. Optimum comfort is attained
by setting the system to automatic mode. Set
the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 260).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on or off using the button on the
centre console
General notes
The colours of the indicator lamps on button : signify the following:
RBlue:
auxiliary ventilation activated
auxiliary heating activated
RYellow: departure time preselected
(Y page 260)
RRed:
Switching on the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
lights up.
Switching off the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
goes out.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on or off using the remote control
General notes
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For more information, please
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Store the remote control for the auxiliary
heating so that the auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on unintentionally. In particular,
ensure that the remote control for the auxiliary heating is kept out of the reach of children.
The remote control has a range of approximately 300 metres. This range is reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
If the remote control battery is low, the battery symbol on the left of the display is shown
as empty. Replace the remote control battery
Rsolid
Z
Climate control
The auxiliary heating switches off when the
engine is switched off. The auxiliary ventilation switches off when you turn the key to key
position 2 (Y page 165).
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 50 minutes.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
157
Operating the climate control system
158
and observe the important safety notes when
doing so (Y page 159).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
Climate control
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
Remote control
: Display
; u Switches on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation/checks status
= . Sets the departure time
? ^ Switches off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , Sets the departure time
To switch on: press and hold the u
button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To switch off: press and hold the ^
button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Briefly press the u button.
The following messages may appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently activated. The
number in the display
shows the remaining
time (in minutes) for the
auxiliary ventilation. If
the vehicle is not started
after this time, the running time is increased by
five minutes.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
activated. The number in
the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating. If the vehicle is
not started after this
time, the running time is
increased by five
minutes.
If the engine has not yet reached operating
temperature when it is started, the auxiliary
heating running time is increased. The auxiliary heating continues to run until the operat-
Operating the climate control system
Setting the departure time
Make sure that the time set in the vehicle is
correct before setting the departure time (see
the separate operating instructions). Otherwise, the auxiliary heating may switch on at
the wrong time and at an unsuitable location.
When setting the departure time, observe the
important safety notes (Y page 156).
X Briefly press the u button.
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons at the
same time.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
X
Press the u and ^ buttons at the
same time.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating the set departure time
X Briefly press the u button.
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol, the departure time and,
depending on the selected departure time,
the letter A, B or C appear in the display.
Deactivating the set departure time
Briefly press the u button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Replacing the remote control battery
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Z
Climate control
ing temperature is reached. If this is the case,
the y symbol appears in the remote control display and the running time is zero
minutes.
159
160
Operating the climate control system
Climate control
Replacing the battery
If the battery needs to be replaced, the battery symbol on the left of the display is shown
as empty. A CR2450 lithium battery is
required when replacing the battery.
X Press a pointed object into recess :.
X Slide battery cover ; backwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove old battery =.
X Insert the new battery with the lettering
facing upwards.
X Slide battery cover ; in the opposite direction to the arrow on the remote control until
it engages.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
Air vents
161
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL¨
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle is
faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation on or off using the remote control.
FAIL
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The starter battery is not sufficiently charged.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating/ventilation using the remote control.
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The fuel tank content is below the reserve fuel level.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation cannot be switched on or has
switched itself off.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation is malfunctioning.
X Have the auxiliary heating/ventilation checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior
i Optimal climate control function is ach-
ieved by opening the air vents fully and setting the adjusters to the middle position.
Z
Climate control
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Air vents
162
Adjusting the centre air vents
To open the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : to the
left.
X To close the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : clockwise as far as it will go.
Climate control
X
Adjusting the side air vents
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; to the left.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; clockwise as far as it will
go.
X
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
: Rear-compartment air vent, left
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
= Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
To open or close: turn thumbwheel = up
or down.
i If the control panel in the front is switched
off, no air can flow through the rear air
vents.
X
163
Useful information ............................ 164
Driving ............................................... 164
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles) .................................................... 174
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles) ................. 175
Manual transmission ........................ 176
Automatic transmission ................... 177
Refuelling ........................................... 188
Parking ............................................... 192
Driving tips ........................................ 195
Driving systems ................................ 199
Towing a trailer ................................. 237
Driving and parking
Running-in notes ............................... 164
164
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RVehicles with automatic transmission:
try to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
After 1500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
Additional notes on running in MercedesAMG vehicles:
Rfor the first 1,500 km do not drive at speeds
above 140 km/h.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly.
You should also observe these notes on running-in if the engine or parts of the drive train
on your vehicle have been replaced.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed.
Ronly
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end
of this teach-in process.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
The first 1500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red
area of the rev counter.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
Rshoes
Driving
Key positions
Key
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
! Do not warm up the engine when the vehicle is stationary. Drive off immediately.
Avoid high engine speeds and driving at full
throttle until the engine has reached its
operating temperature.
Only shift the automatic transmission to
the desired drive position when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. You could otherwise damage the
drive train.
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles: avoid full-load
operation and engine speeds greater than
5000 rpm when the engine is cold. This will
help to protect the engine and maintain
smooth engine operation.
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the vehicle
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
steering is locked when the key is taken out of
the ignition lock.
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on.
The engine cannot be started.
Start/Stop button
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
keys featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example, when starting
the engine.
When you insert the Start/Stop button into
the ignition lock, the system needs approximately two seconds recognition time. You
can then use the Start/Stop button.
Z
Driving and parking
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
165
166
Driving
Driving and parking
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. Pre-requisite for this is that:
Ryou
do not depress the brake pedal (vehicles with automatic transmission)
Ryou do not depress the clutch pedal (vehicles with manual transmission)
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately (vehicles with automatic transmission).
If you depress the clutch pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately (vehicles with manual transmission).
To start the vehicle without actively using the
key:
Rthe
Start/Stop button must be inserted in
the ignition lock
Rthe key must be in the vehicle
Rthe vehicle must not be locked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO (Y page 87)
Do not keep the KEYLESS-GO key:
Rwith
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the functionality of KEYLESSGO.
If you lock the vehicle with the key's remote
control or with KEYLESS-GO, after a short
time:
function operates independently of the ECO
start/stop automatic engine switch-off function.
Key positions with the Start/Stop button
: Start/Stop button
; Ignition lock
When you switch on the ignition, all of the
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up. Further information on situations where
an indicator lamp either fails to go out after
starting the engine or lights up while driving
(Y page 303).
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
X To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can
now activate the windscreen wipers, for
example.
The power supply is switched off again if:
Rthe
driver's door is opened and
Ryou will not be able to switch on the ignition
Ryou press Start/Stop button : twice when
Ryou will not be able to start the engine with
X
with the Start/Stop button
the Start/Stop button until the vehicle is
unlocked again
If you lock the vehicle centrally using the button on the front door (Y page 94), you can
continue to start the engine with the Start/
Stop button.
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding the
Start/Stop button for three seconds. This
in this position
To switch on the ignition: press Start/
Stop button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
If you press Start/Stop button : once
when in this position, the ignition is deactivated again.
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
You can only switch between Start/Stop button mode and key operation when the vehicle
is stationary.
You must also engage park position P (vehicles with automatic transmission).
X Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you leave
the vehicle. You should, however, always take
the key with you when leaving the vehicle. As
long as the key is in the vehicle:
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
Rthe
vehicle can be started using the Start/
Stop button
Rthe electrically powered equipment can be
operated
Starting the vehicle
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
Rget out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
G WARNING
! Do not depress the accelerator when
starting the engine.
General notes
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine
runs at a higher engine speed during the cold
start procedure so that the catalytic converter can reach operating temperature more
quickly. The sound of the engine may change
as a result.
Manual transmission
You can only start the engine when the clutch
pedal is fully depressed.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to neutral N.
Z
167
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving
168
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
X
Shift the transmission to position P
(Y page 178).
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P
(Y page 178).
i You can start the engine in transmission
position P and N.
Starting procedure with the key
To start the engine using the key instead of
the Start/Stop button, pull the Start/Stop
button out of the ignition lock.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 165).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165) and release it as soon as
the engine is running.
Starting procedure using the Start/
Stop button
The Start/Stop button can be used to start
the vehicle manually without inserting the key
into the ignition lock. The key must be in the
vehicle and the Start/Stop button must be
inserted in the ignition lock. This mode for
starting the engine operates independently of
the ECO start/stop automatic engine start
function.
You can start the engine if a valid key is in the
vehicle. Switch off the engine and always take
the key with you when leaving the vehicle,
even if you only leave it for a short time. Pay
attention to the important safety notes.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 165).
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine
starts.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: preglow is
activated and the engine starts.
X
Pulling away
General notes
G WARNING
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
If the engine speed is above the engine idling
speed and you then engage transmission
position D or R, the vehicle may accelerate
suddenly. There is a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always keep the brake pedal firmly depressed
and do not depress the accelerator pedal at
the same time.
! Vehicles with manual transmission:
change gear in good time and avoid spinning the wheels. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
Depress the accelerator carefully when pulling away.
The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at any
time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking
feature (Y page 260).
Vehicles with automatic transmission: it
is only possible to shift the transmission from
position P to the desired position if you
depress the brake pedal. Only then can the
parking lock be deactivated.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): if you do not depress the brake pedal,
the DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved
but the parking lock remains engaged.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: if you do not
depress the brake pedal, the selector lever
can still be moved but the parking lock
remains engaged.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: at
transmission fluid temperatures below
Ò20 †, you can only shift out of position P into
another transmission position when the
engine is running.
i Vehicles with automatic transmis-
sion: upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
information on automatically releasing the
electric parking brake (Y page 193).
Pulling away with a trailer
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster remains lit.
X Depress the accelerator pedal.
X As soon as the vehicle/trailer combination
is held by the driving force of the engine,
release lever :.
the electric parking brake is released
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
For further information on the electric parking
brake, see (Y page 193).
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It
holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
After a while, hill start assist no longer holds
the vehicle and it may roll away. There is a risk
of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou
To ensure that you do not roll backwards
when pulling away on an uphill slope, apply
the electric parking brake.
X Press and hold handle :.
The electric parking brake continues to
brake and prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards.
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is in position N
Rthe electric parking brake is applied
RESP® is malfunctioning
Further information on holding the vehicle
stationary on uphill gradients (Y page 182).
Z
169
Driving and parking
Driving
170
Driving
ECO start/stop function
Driving and parking
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
: ECO start/stop display
The ECO start/stop function is activated
whenever you start the engine using the key
or the Start/Stop button.
If the è ECO symbol is shown in green in
the multifunction display, the ECO start/stop
function switches the engine off automatically once the vehicle stops moving.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 171) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the è ECO symbol is not displayed.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the ECO start/
stop function is only available in drive program C.
Automatic engine switch-off
General notes
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the è ECO symbol is displayed in
green in the multifunction display, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If the conditions for automatic engine switchoff are not all fulfilled, the è ECO symbol is
shown in yellow.
All of the vehicle's systems remain active
when the engine is switched off automatically.
The engine can be switched off automatically
a maximum of four times (initial stop, then
three subsequent stops) in succession. The
è ECO symbol is shown in yellow in the
multifunction display after the engine has
been started automatically for the fourth
time. When the è ECO symbol is shown in
green in the multifunction display, automatic
engine switch-off is again possible.
Vehicles with manual transmission
Driving
Vehicles with automatic transmission
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill with the
transmission in D or N, the ECO start/stop
function switches off the engine automatically.
The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It
is then not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase.
When you depress the accelerator pedal, the
engine starts automatically and the braking
effect of the HOLD function is deactivated.
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rdepress
Rdepress
the clutch pedal fully
the accelerator pedal
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rrelease
the brake pedal in transmission
position D or N when the HOLD function is
not active
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
Rmove the transmission out of position P
Shifting the transmission to position P does
not start the engine.
If you shift the transmission from R to D, the
ECO start/stop function is available again
once the è ECO symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
Switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on
Automatic engine start
General notes
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
Vehicles with manual transmission
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
X
To deactivate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the è ECO symbol in the multifunction display go out.
X
To activate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 170) are fulfilled, the
è ECO symbol is shown in green in the
multifunction display.
If the conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 170) are not all fulfilled,
the è ECO symbol is shown in yellow in
the multifunction display. If this is the case,
Z
Driving and parking
The ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically at low speeds.
X Brake the vehicle.
X Shift to neutral N (Y page 176) (follow
gearshift instruction : to shift into neutral
N, if necessary).
X Release the clutch pedal.
The engine is switched off automatically.
171
Driving
172
Driving and parking
the ECO start/stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; on ECO button : is off,
the ECO start/stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The engine will then not be switched
off automatically when the vehicle stops.
AMG performance exhaust system
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
You can choose between different AMG Performance exhaust system volumes using the
position of the exhaust flap.
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected setting is activated when the engine is next started. If the
ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, the quietest setting is activated when
the engine is next started.
Setting the volume:
X
Press button :.
If you select the loudest setting, indicator
lamp ; lights up.
The volume of the AMG Performance exhaust
system can also be set using the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller (Y page 175).
Driving
173
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 211) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 204).
X Try to start the engine again.
RThere is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor RThere is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
can be heard.
Before attempting to start the engine again:
X Turn the key back to position 0 in the ignition lock.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps
in the instrument cluster go out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 167). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 360).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
X
If the engine still does not start:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Driving and parking
174
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
coolant warning lamp
cool down.
may also be on and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 338). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
DYNAMIC SELECT button (all vehicles
except Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
hours, drive program C is activated when the
engine is next started.
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to change
the drive program. Depending on the drive
program selected, the following vehicle characteristics will change:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with damping system or AMG RIDE CONTROL)
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe climate control
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
X
Press DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as
many times as necessary until the desired
drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds
the display goes out and the status icon of
the selected drive program appears.
In addition, the current drive program settings are displayed briefly in the Audio 20 or
COMAND Online display.
i In a few countries, the ECO start/stop
function is deactivated at the factory due to
the quality of the available fuel. In this case,
the ECO start/stop function is not available
in any drive program, regardless of the display in the Audio 20 or COMAND Online
display.
Available drive programs:
C Comfort
Comfortable and economical driving characteristics
S Sport
Sporty driving characteristics
I Individual
Individual settings
E Economy
Particularly economical
driving characteristics
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 183).
You can also change gear yourself using the
steering wheel gearshift paddles. Further
information on the manual drive program
(Y page 185).
DYNAMIC SELECT controller
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT controller to
change the drive program. Depending on the
drive program selected, the following vehicle
characteristics will change:
Rthe
drive
transmission management
RESP®
Rthe suspension (vehicles with AMG RIDE
CONTROL)
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe availability of gliding mode
Rthe
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, drive program C is activated when the
engine is next started.
X
Turn DYNAMIC SELECT controller : as
many times as necessary until the desired
drive program is selected.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display. After five seconds
the display goes out and the status icon of
the selected drive program appears.
The drive program indicator on DYNAMIC
SELECT controller : lights up in red.
Available drive programs:
I Individual
Individual settings
C Comfort
Comfort-orientated,
engine and transmission
settings optimised for
economy
S Sport
Sporty engine and transmission settings
S+ Sport Plus
Particularly sporty transmission settings
RACE
Maximum sportiness and
engine and transmission
settings suitable for the
racetrack
Additional information for drive programs
(Y page 183).
Z
175
Driving and parking
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
176
Manual transmission
Driving and parking
You can also change gear yourself using the
steering wheel gearshift paddles. Further
information on the manual drive program
(Y page 185).
Shifting to neutral N
Manual transmission
Gear lever
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
! When shifting to 5th and 6th gear, you
must press the shift lever to the right. Otherwise, you could shift unintentionally into
3rd or 4th gear and damage the engine or
transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine
to overrev, leading to engine damage.
Do not use the clutch bite point to keep the
vehicle stationary on uphill gradients.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
clutch.
! On long and steep downhill gradients,
especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a
trailer, you must shift into gear 1, 2 or 3 in
good time. This uses the engine's braking
effect. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
k
Reverse gear
1 - 6 Forward gears
X
X
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
Shift the gear lever to position N :.
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could
damage the transmission.
X
Pull the gear lever up, push it to the left and
then pull it back.
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. Further information on the ECO start/stop function
(Y page 170).
Gearshift recommendation
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift gear according to gearshift recommendation : when shown in the multifunction display of the instrument cluster.
Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission
Drive program C (Comfort)
Important safety notes
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
Rthe
vehicle delivers comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle having improved driving stability, for example on slippery road surfaces.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine settings.
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with damping system)
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe climate control
Information about configuring drive program I
with COMAND Online or Audio 20 can be
found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
Drive program E (Economy)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle having improved driving stability, for example on slippery road surfaces.
Rthe performance of the air-conditioning and
heating systems is reduced.
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): the DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right
of the steering column.
Z
Driving and parking
Drive programs
177
Driving and parking
178
Automatic transmission
For information on the selector lever in
Mercedes-AMG vehicles (Y page 180).
The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns to
its original position. The current transmission
position P, R, N or D appears in the transmission position display in the multifunction display (Y page 178).
Transmission position and drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
j
k
i
h
X
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
Engaging park position P
When you have engaged park position P,
make sure that the transmission position display shows P in the multifunction display.
You can only engage park position P when the
vehicle is stationary.
Depressing the brake and pushing the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down disengages
the parking lock. The transmission is in neutral N.
At transmission fluid temperatures below
Ò20 †, you can only shift out of park position
P into another transmission position when
the engine is running.
In order to shift from park position P directly
into R or D:
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
Rdepress
: Transmission position
; Gear
= Drive program display
The arrows in the transmission position display show how and into which transmission
positions you can shift using the DIRECT
SELECT lever.
If the transmission position display in the multifunction display is not working, you should
pull away carefully to check whether the
desired transmission position is engaged.
Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or S.
the automatic transmission directly from D
to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise,
the automatic transmission could be damaged.
the brake pedal and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
past the first point of resistance
Rpush
Automatic transmission
Park position P is automatically engaged if:
Shifting to neutral N
Ryou switch off the engine using the key and
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ryou
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
remove the key
switch off the engine using the key or
using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door or front-passenger door
Ryou open the driver's door when the vehicle
is stationary or when driving at a very low
speed and the transmission is in position D
or R
Under certain conditions, the automatic
transmission shifts automatically to transmission position P if the HOLD function or
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Observe the
information on the HOLD function
(Y page 212) and on DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 207).
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
If the transmission is in position D or N:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever up past the first point of
resistance.
X
The ECO start/stop function is not available
when reverse gear is engaged. Further information on the ECO start/stop function
(Y page 170).
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
If the transmission is in position D or R:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever up or down to the first point of
resistance.
X
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open the driver's
door or the front-passenger door or remove
the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P automatically.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then
open the driver's door or the front-passenger
door, the automatic transmission shifts to P
automatically.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the
vehicle cleaned in an automatic car wash with
a towing system:
Z
Driving and parking
Engaging park position P automatically
179
Automatic transmission
180
With the key:
Switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
Driving and parking
X
Selector lever (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
Overview of transmission positions
With the Start/Stop button:
Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X Switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
Transmission position and drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
Engaging drive position D
If the transmission is in position R or N:
push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
X If the transmission is in position P: depress
the brake pedal and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever down past the first point of
resistance.
X
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
If the transmission position display in the multifunction display is not working, you should
pull away carefully to check whether the
desired transmission position is engaged.
Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program C or S.
Automatic transmission
Transmission positions
B
X
When the vehicle is stationary, press button :.
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped.
Only shift the transmission into
position P when the vehicle is stationary (Y page 178). The parking
lock should not be used as a brake
when parking. In order to secure
the vehicle, always apply the electric parking brake in addition to the
parking lock.
In the event of a malfunction of the
vehicle's electronics, the transmission may lock in position P. Have
the vehicle electronics checked
immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Park position P is automatically
engaged if:
Ryou
switch off the engine using
the key and remove the key
Ryou switch off the engine using
the key or using the Start/Stop
button and open the driver's
door or front-passenger door
Ryou open the driver's door when
the vehicle is stationary or when
driving at a very low speed and
the transmission is in position D
or R
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission into
position R when the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
Engaging park position P
181
182
Automatic transmission
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
shift the transmission to position N
if the vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
If you switch the engine off with the
transmission in position R or D, the
automatic transmission shifts to N
automatically.
Driving and parking
A
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
7
Driving tips
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Rthe
selected drive program
position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
Holding the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients
G WARNING
If the clutch overheats, the electronic management system is automatically deactivated.
This interrupts the power transmission. The
vehicle may, for example, roll backwards on
gradients. There is a risk of an accident.
Never hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator.
The clutch may overheat if you hold the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients by depressing the accelerator pedal. If the clutch overheats, a warning tone sounds.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): the Stop vehicle Shift to P
Leave engine running display message
appears in the multifunction display. You will
only be able to continue your journey once the
clutch has cooled down and the display message in the multifunction display has disappeared.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the Trans. oil
overheated Drive on with care display
message appears in the multifunction display.
Do not hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator
pedal. Instead, only ever hold the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients by:
Rdepressing
the brake pedal
the HOLD function
Rengaging the electric parking brake
Ractivating
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration:
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Automatic transmission
Towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see
(Y page 239).
X Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Depending on the uphill or downhill gradient, select a lower gear (Y page 197), even
if cruise control, DISTRONIC PLUS, or
SPEEDTRONIC are activated.
Drive programs
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle delivers comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle having improved driving stability, for example on slippery road surfaces.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. The vehicle is driven in the low
engine speed range and the wheels are less
likely to spin.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine settings.
automatic transmission shifting up
later. as a result of the later automatic
transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Rthe
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe
drive (engine and transmission management)
Rthe suspension (vehicles with damping system or AMG RIDE CONTROL)
Rthe steering
Rthe availability of the ECO start/stop function
Rthe climate control
Information about configuring drive program I
with COMAND Online or Audio 20 can be
found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
i To permanently select the gears in drive
program I using the steering wheel paddles, select the M (manual) setting for the
drive.
Drive program E (Economy)
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented
engine settings.
fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle having improved driving stability, for example on slippery road surfaces.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
Roptimal
Z
Driving and parking
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: it is only possible
to use kickdown in the automatic drive programs and in temporary manual drive program M. When manual drive program M is
selected permanently, kickdown is not possible.
For further information on kickdown in manual drive program M (Y page 187).
183
Driving and parking
184
Automatic transmission
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Rgliding mode is activated automatically
when engine-internal conditions are fulfilled and the accelerator is not depressed. At
the same time the transmission’s clutch
opens and the vehicle rolls freely using its
kinetic energy. As a result great distances
can be completed without the engine brake
and fuel consumption reduced.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Drive program I (Individual)
In drive program I the following properties of
the drive program can be selected:
Rthe
drive (engine management)
transmission management
Rthe suspension (vehicles with AMG RIDE
CONTROL)
RESP®
Information about configuring drive program I
with COMAND Online or Audio 20 can be
found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Rthe
Drive program C (Comfort)
Drive program C is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle delivers comfortable, economical driving characteristics.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rthe vehicle having improved driving stability, for example on slippery road surfaces.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. The vehicle is driven in the low
engine speed range and the wheels are less
likely to spin.
Rgliding mode is available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is available.
Drive program S (Sport)
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits sporty driving characteristics
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later. as a result of the later automatic
transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits stiff springing and
damping settings (vehicles with AIR RIDE
CONTROL).
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Drive program S+ (Sport Plus)
Drive program S+ is characterised by the following:
Rthe vehicle exhibits particularly sporty driv-
ing characteristics.
automatic transmission shifting up
later.
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly stiff
springing and damping settings (vehicles
with AIR RIDE CONTROL).
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Rthe
Drive program RACE (vehicles with AMG
RIDE CONTROL)
Drive program RACE is characterised by the
following:
Rthe
vehicle exhibits driving characteristics
suitable for the racetrack.
Rall vehicle systems are set for maximum
sportiness.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later.
Automatic transmission
a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Rthe suspension exhibits particularly stiff
springing and damping settings (vehicles
with AIR RIDE CONTROL).
Rgliding mode is not available.
Rthe ECO start/stop function is not available.
Manual gearshifting
General notes
You can change gear yourself using the steering wheel gearshift paddles. The transmission
must be in position D.
Depending on which gearshift paddle is
pulled, the automatic transmission immediately shifts into the next gear up or down, if
permitted.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: to use manual
shifting, you have two options:
Rtemporary
setting
setting
If you activate manual gearshifting, the multifunction display will show the current gear
instead of transmission position D.
If manual gearshifting is deactivated, the
gears will be selected automatically.
Rpermanent
To activate: shift the DIRECT SELECT lever
to position D.
X Pull steering wheel gearshift paddle :
or ;.
X
Temporary setting will be active for a certain
amount of time. Under certain conditions the
minimum amount of time is extended, e.g. in
the case of lateral acceleration, during an
overrun phase or when driving on steep terrain.
X To deactivate: pull steering wheel gearshift paddle ; and hold it in place.
or
X Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to shift the
transmission position.
or
X All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG vehicles): use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to
change the drive program.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: use the DYNAMIC
SELECT controller to change the drive program.
Permanent setting (Mercedes-AMG
vehicles)
Temporary setting
To activate: shift the selector lever to position D.
X Press button :.
X
X
To deactivate: press button :.
or
X
If position D (automatic transmission) is
selected for the transmission in drive proZ
Driving and parking
Ras
185
Automatic transmission
186
gram I: shift to drive program I with the
DYNAMIC SELECT controller.
Gearshift recommendation
Driving and parking
Shifting gears
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the automatic
transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting speed
for the current gear is reached. When the
engine limiting speed is reached, the fuel
supply is cut to prevent the engine from
overrevving. Always make sure that the
engine speed does not reach the red area of
the rev counter. There is otherwise a risk of
engine damage.
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display.
Upshifting (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
! The automatic transmission does not shift
To shift up: pull steering wheel gearshift
paddle ;.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG
vehicles): if the maximum engine speed on
the currently engaged gear is reached and
you continue to accelerate, the automatic
transmission automatically shifts up in
order to prevent engine damage.
X To shift down: pull steering wheel gearshift paddle :.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
Automatic downshifting occurs when
coasting.
If the engine exceeds the maximum engine
speed when shifting down, the automatic
transmission protects against engine damage by not shifting down.
X
up automatically even when the engine limiting speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. Always make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. There is otherwise
a risk of engine damage.
Before the engine speed reaches the red area,
an upshift indicator will be shown in the multifunction display.
X Shift to recommended gear : when message ; is shown in the multifunction display.
Automatic transmission
187
Kickdown
For maximum acceleration, depress the
accelerator pedal beyond the pressure
point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
Driving and parking
X
During kickdown, you cannot shift gears
using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
If you apply full throttle, the automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear when the
maximum engine speed is reached. This prevents the engine from overrevving.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: it is only possible
to use kickdown in temporary manual drive
program M. When manual drive program M is
selected permanently, kickdown is not possible.
Z
188
Refuelling
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
X Stop.
The transmission no
X Shift the transmission to position P.
longer shifts into all of
X Switch off the engine.
the gears.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
Reverse gear can no
X Shift the transmission to position D.
longer be engaged.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf
fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
G WARNING
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
Refuelling
Opening the fuel filler flap
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. The repair costs are high.
Notify a qualified specialist workshop and
have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the fuel injection
system could otherwise be blocked by particles from the fuel can.
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may
spray out when you remove the fuel pump
nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 402).
Refuelling
General notes
The fuel filler flap is unlocked/locked automatically when you unlock/lock the vehicle
with the key.
The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed
æ in the instrument cluster. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
:
;
=
?
To open the fuel filler flap
Tyre pressure table
To insert the fuel filler cap
Instruction label on the fuel type to be
refuelled
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's
door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder on
the inside of fuel filler flap =.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place
and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
X
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the filler neck is
designed for refuelling at diesel filling pumps.
Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise, fuel
may leak out.
Z
Driving and parking
fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel
system. Even small amounts of the wrong
fuel can result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
189
Refuelling
190
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
Driving and parking
X
Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle.
Refuelling
191
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
vehicle.
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Turn the key to position 0 immediately and remove it
(Y page 165).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
start.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for approximately ten seconds
(Y page 165).
X Start the engine continuously for a maximum of ten seconds
until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again a maximum of ten seconds
(Y page 165).
X Start the engine again continuously for a maximum of ten seconds until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 87).
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 89).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
192
Parking
Rthe
Parking
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is safeguarded
against rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied.
Ron
vehicles with manual transmission,
engage 1st gear or reverse gear.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission must be in position P and
the transmission position display must
show P in the multifunction display.
key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron uphill or downhill gradients, the front
wheels must be turned towards the kerb.
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Vehicles with manual transmission
Shift to either 1st gear or reverse gear R.
With the key: turn the key to position 0 in
the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With the Start/Stop button: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 165).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0: "key removed".
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
X
Apply the electric parking brake.
X
All vehicles (except Mercedes-AMG
vehicles): shift the transmission to position P.
Parking
193
Release the brake pedal.
Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
With the Start/Stop button:
Remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X Switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
X
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: press button :.
With the key: turn the key to position 0 in
the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X With the Start/Stop button: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 165).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0: "key removed".
X
If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
With the key: if you then open the driver's
door or the front-passenger door or remove
the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P automatically.
With the Start/Stop button: if you then
open the driver's door or the front-passenger
door, the automatic transmission shifts to P
automatically.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N, e.g. when having the
vehicle cleaned in an automatic car wash with
a towing system:
With the key:
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Switch the ignition on.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral N.
X
Z
Driving and parking
X
Parking
Driving and parking
194
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction in the system, it may not be possible to
apply the released parking brake.
If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it from
rolling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first gear.
X
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or
if there is a malfunction in the system. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
The electric parking brake carries out a function check at regular intervals when the
engine is switched off. Noises that occur are
normal.
Applying or releasing manually
The electric parking brake can only be
released:
Rwhen
the key is in position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 165) or
Rif the ignition was switched on using the
Start/Stop button
Applying automatically (vehicles with
automatic transmission)
The electric parking brake is automatically
applied when the transmission is in position P
and:
Rthe
engine is switched off or
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is opened
To prevent the electric parking brake from
being automatically applied, pull handle :.
The electric parking brake is also engaged
automatically if:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS brings the vehicle to a
standstill or
Rthe HOLD function is keeping the vehicle
stationary
RActive Parking Assist is keeping the vehicle
stationary
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthere
is a system malfunction
power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically applied if the engine is switched off by
the ECO start/stop function.
Rthe
X
X
To apply: push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red ! indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake can also be
applied when the key is removed.
To release: pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Applying automatically (vehicles with
manual transmission)
When the vehicle's HOLD function is holding
the vehicle at a standstill, the electric parking
brake is applied automatically.
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
X
engine is switched off
Rthe driver is not wearing a seat belt and the
driver's door is open
is a system malfunction
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
The electric parking brake is not automatically applied if the engine is switched off by
the ECO start/stop function.
Rthere
Releasing automatically
The electric parking brake can only be
released automatically in vehicles with automatic transmission.
The electric parking brake of your vehicle is
released automatically when all of the following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe
engine is running
transmission is in position D or R
Rthe seat belt is fastened
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
If the transmission is in position R, the tailgate
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
Rthe
Rthe
driver's door is closed
Ryou have shifted out of transmission position P or you have previously driven faster
than 3 km/h
Ensure that you do not depress the accelerator pedal unintentionally. Otherwise, the
parking brake will be released and the vehicle
will start to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an
emergency by using the electric parking
brake.
While driving, push handle : of the electric
parking brake (Y page 193).
The vehicle is braked as long as you keep
handle : of the electric parking brake
pressed. The longer the electric parking
brake handle : is depressed, the greater
the braking force.
During braking:
Ra
warning tone sounds
Release park. brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Rthe
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, it may suffer from lack of use.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving tips
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Z
195
Driving and parking
Driving tips
196
Driving tips
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Observe the following tips to save fuel:
Driving and parking
RThe
tyres should always be inflated to the
recommended tyre pressure.
RRemove unnecessary loads.
RRemove roof racks when they are not needed.
RWarm up the engine at low engine speeds.
RAvoid frequent acceleration or braking.
RHave all maintenance work carried out as
indicated by the service intervals in the
Service Booklet or by the service interval
display.
Fuel consumption also increases when driving in cold weather, in stop-start traffic, on
short journeys and in hilly terrain.
ECO display
The ECO display provides feedback on how
economical your driving characteristics are.
The ECO display assists you in achieving the
most economical driving style for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by
your driving style.
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percentage count is the mean value of the
three bar values. The three bars and the mean
value begin at the value of 50%. A higher percentage count indicates a more economical
driving style.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption. A fixed percentage count
in the ECO display does not indicate a fixed
consumption.
In addition to driving style, the consumption is
affected by many other factors, such as:
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
The evaluation of your driving style takes the
following three categories into consideration:
RAcceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
- the bar fills up: moderate acceleration,
especially at higher speeds
- the bar empties: sporty acceleration
RConstant (assessment of driving behaviour at all times:)
- the bar fills up: constant speed and
avoidance of unnecessary acceleration
and deceleration
- the bar empties: fluctuations in speed
RCoasting (assessment of all deceleration
processes):
- the bar fills up: anticipatory driving, keeping your distance and early release of the
accelerator. The vehicle can coast without use of the brakes.
- the bar empties: frequent braking
An economical driving style involves driving at
a moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
Acceleration and Constant
Constant:
Robserve the gearshift recommendation
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program C or E
(vehicles with DYNAMIC SELECT button).
On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g. on
the motorway, only the bar for Constant will
change.
The ECO display summarises the driving characteristics from the start of the journey to its
Rcold
Driving tips
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle and
when towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to activate
manual gearshifting (Y page 185).
This also applies if you have activated cruise
control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal on
downhill gradients while the manual drive
program M is temporarily activated (vehicles
with automatic transmission): the automatic
transmission may switch back to the last
active automatic drive program E or S. The
automatic transmission may shift to a higher
gear. This can reduce the engine's braking
effect.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If heavy demands are made on the brakes, do
not park the vehicle immediately. Drive on for
a short while. This allows the airflow to cool
the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed, paying attention to traffic conditions. This improves the grip of the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of
salt may form on the brake discs and pads.
Z
Driving and parking
completion. Therefore, there are dynamic
changes in the bars at the start of a journey.
During a prolonged driving time, these
changes are smaller. For more dynamic
changes, perform a manual reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 250).
197
Driving and parking
198
Driving tips
This can increase the braking distance considerably.
RIn order to prevent any salt build-up, apply
the brakes occasionally while paying attention to the traffic conditions.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the
end of the journey and when starting the
next journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the
vehicle in front.
New brake pads/linings
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
are driving at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, drive in the following manner
in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in
which aquaplaning can occur:
Rthe
Rlower
your speed
Ravoid tyre ruts
Ravoid sudden steering movements
Rbrake carefully
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you must drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rin
the case of standing water, the water
level must be no higher than the lower edge
of the vehicle body
Ryou should drive no faster than walking
pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres. Do
not use cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing point.
Further information on driving with snow
chains (Y page 373).
Further information on driving with summer
tyres (Y page 372).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 372).
Driving systems
of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions are appropriate for maintaining a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
The speed indicated in the speedometer may
differ slightly from the speed stored.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. Cruise control is
only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
for braking in good time, and for staying in
lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
in heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. You must
select a lower gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual shift drive program M
(Y page 185). By doing so, you will make use
Z
199
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
200
Cruise control lever
Activation conditions
Driving and parking
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
? To activate or reduce speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds.
Selecting cruise control
To select cruise control: check whether
LIM indicator lamp ; is on or off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
X
electric parking brake must be
released.
Ryou are driving faster than 30 km/h.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the selector lever must be in position D.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, a
gear must be engaged.
Rcruise control must be selected.
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically braking the vehicle.
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
RAlways drive
at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds.
RChange gear in good time.
RIf possible, do not change down several
gears at a time.
Driving systems
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Setting a speed
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ? to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : or down ? beyond the
pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Brake.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Rthe
vehicle is secured with the electric
parking brake
Ryou are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rwhile driving a vehicle with manual transmission, you shift into neutral or depress
the clutch pedal for longer than six seconds
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high, and as a
result the engine speed is too low
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
you shift to position N while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Z
Driving and parking
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
201
202
Driving systems
SPEEDTRONIC
Driving and parking
General notes
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. You must
select a lower gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual shift drive program M
(Y page 185). By doing so, you will make use
of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly. If you need additional
braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly
rather than continuously.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 204)
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
? To activate or reduce speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
Important safety notes
RLIM
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics.
SPEEDTRONIC cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time, and for staying in lane.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected
When the engine is running, you can use the
cruise control lever to limit the speed to any
speed between 30 km/h and the technically
permitted maximum speed of the vehicle. If
the set value of permanent SPEEDTRONIC is
lower then this value applies (Y page 204).
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
X Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
Driving systems
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ?.
The current speed is stored and shown in
the multifunction display.
Storing or calling up the speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
Setting a speed
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : beyond the pressure point
for a higher speed, or down ? for a lower
speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ? for a
lower speed.
X
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ? for a lower
speed.
Switching SPEEDTRONIC to passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the pressure point (kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC is switched to passive mode. The following message appears in the multifunction
display: SPEEDTRONIC passive.
passive
You can then exceed the stored speed.
SPEEDTRONIC is activated again if you:
Rdrive slower than the stored speed without
kickdown
Rset a new speed or
Rcall up the last speed stored again
The SPEEDTRONIC passive message in the
multifunction display disappears.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
SPEEDTRONIC switches off if you shift to a
higher gear and as a result, the engine speed
is too low.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Z
Driving and parking
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
203
204
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 259).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. Vehicles are detected with the aid of the radar
sensor system. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes
automatically to avoid exceeding the set
speed or to maintain the designated distance
from the vehicle in front.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on
the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention,
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision.
An intermittent warning tone will then sound
and the distance warning lamp will light up in
the instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
DISTRONIC PLUS operates in the range
between 0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to:
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
As a result, DISTRONIC PLUS may neither give
warnings nor intervene in such situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly recognise other road users and complex traffic
conditions.
In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate or brake unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be prepared to
brake, particularly if DISTRONIC PLUS warns
you.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up
to 50% of the maximum possible deceleration.
If this deceleration is not sufficient,
DISTRONIC PLUS alerts you with a visual and
acoustic warning. There is a risk of an accident.
Apply the brakes yourself in these situations
and try to take evasive action.
! When DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD
function is activated, the vehicle brakes
automatically in certain situations.
Driving systems
Rwhen
towing away
Rin a car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style,
DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk
of an accident nor override the laws of physics. DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take road and
weather conditions or traffic conditions into
account. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle
in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time and for staying in lane.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
in heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow
vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
If DISTRONIC PLUS no longer detects a vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate to
the speed stored.
This speed can:
Rsnow
Rbe
too high for a filter lane or a slip road
Rbe so high in the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the left
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the right
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
Driving and parking
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS and the HOLD function in
the following or similar situations:
205
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed or to call up the
last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
You can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control
lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
Z
Driving and parking
206
Driving systems
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, all of the following activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before
DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe electric parking brake must be
released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RActive Parking Assist must not be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and the rear
doors must be closed.
Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS function must be
selected with the cruise control lever
(Y page 205).
Activating
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?, up : or down A.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up :
or down A until the desired speed is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS inactive
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
The position of the accelerator pedal will
determine the speed.
You can also activate DISTRONIC PLUS when
stationary. The lowest speed that can be set is
30 km/h.
Driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
Pulling away and driving
The vehicle can also pull away when it is
facing an unidentified obstacle or is driving on
a different line from another vehicle. The vehicle then brakes automatically. Be ready to
brake at all times.
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated when you
depress the brake, except when the vehicle is
stationary.
X If you want to pull away with
DISTRONIC PLUS: remove your foot from
the brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
or
X Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
If no vehicle is detected in front, your vehicle accelerates to the set speed.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle.
In this way, the distance you have selected is
maintained.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed.
The vehicle is only accelerated up to the
speed you have stored.
Driving systems
Changing lanes
If you change to the overtaking lane,
DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
Ryou
are driving faster than 70 km/h
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou switch on the respective turn signal
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
RDISTRONIC
Stopping
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked
only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated
with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed,
e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
Further information on deactivating
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 209).
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it
is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
when the vehicle is stationary and:
Ra
system fault occurs
power supply is insufficient
If a malfunction in the electric parking brake
occurs, then the transmission may also be
shifted into position P automatically.
Rthe
Z
Driving and parking
Selecting the drive program
DISTRONIC PLUS supports a sporty driving
style when you select the S+ drive program
(Mercedes-AMG vehicles only), S
(Y page 183) or the manual drive program
(Y page 185). Acceleration behind the vehicle
in front or to the set speed is then noticeably
more dynamic. If you have selected the E (C in
Mercedes-AMG vehicles:) drive program, the
vehicle accelerates more gently. This setting
is recommended in stop-start traffic.
207
208
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Setting a speed
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS maintains to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 209).
i Make sure that you maintain the miniBear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
mum distance to the vehicle in front as
required by law. Adjust the distance to the
vehicle in front if necessary.
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
Driving systems
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
vehicle is skidding
activate Active Parking Assist
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the
DISTRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
209
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the instrument cluster
Displays in the speedometer
There are several ways to deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
If you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you will
see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message in the
multifunction display for approximately five
seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine. DISTRONIC PLUS
is not deactivated if you depress the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the
electric parking brake
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door or one of the rear doors is
open
Example: DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the speedometer
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated and there
are no vehicles detected in front, one or two
segments ; in the set speed range light up.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front = and stored speed : light up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
In the Assistance menu (Y page 255) of the
on-board computer, you can select the assistance graphic.
Z
Driving and parking
Ryou
Driving systems
210
Driving and parking
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 255).
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
Assistance graphic
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
Cornering, entering and exiting a bend
the vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehicle in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 255).
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
You will initially see the stored speed for
about five seconds when you activate
DISTRONIC PLUS.
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
Assistance graphic
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? DISTRONIC PLUS active (text only
appears when the cruise control lever is
actuated)
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
which are not driving in the middle of their
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front will
be too short.
Driving systems
Other vehicles changing lane
211
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Driving and parking
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
narrow vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may detect vehicles that
are crossing your lane by mistake. Activating
DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example, could cause your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway
because of its narrow width. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
Z
212
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
Activating the HOLD function
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! When DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD
function is activated, the vehicle brakes
automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS and the HOLD function in
the following or similar situations:
Rwhen
towing away
Rin a car wash
Deactivating the HOLD function
(Y page 212).
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat
belt is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N on
vehicles with automatic transmission
Rthe
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou accelerate. On vehicles with automatic
transmission: only when the transmission
is in position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P on vehicles
with automatic transmission.
Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until : disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric
parking brake.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Driving systems
Rthe driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle is stationary and:
Ra
system fault occurs
power supply is insufficient
Rthe
Vehicles with manual transmission
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated and:
Rthe driver's seat belt is not fastened and the
driver's door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
The Brake immediately message may also
appear in the multifunction display.
X Immediately depress the brake pedal firmly
until the warning message in the multifunction display goes out.
The HOLD function is deactivated.
A horn will sound at regular intervals if you
turn off the engine, take off your seat belt or
open the driver's door when the HOLD function is activated. The horn alerts you to the
fact that the HOLD function is still activated.
If you attempt to lock the vehicle, the tone
becomes louder. The vehicle cannot be
locked until you have deactivated the HOLD
function.
i Once you have switched off the engine,
you cannot restart it until you have deactivated the HOLD function.
Start-off assist (except MercedesAMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use start-off assist, individual wheels
may start to spin and the vehicle may skid. If
ESP® is deactivated, there is a greater danger
of skidding and having an accident. Make sure
that no persons or obstacles are in the area
around the vehicle.
Start-off assist enables optimum acceleration
from a standstill. For this, a suitably high-grip
road surface is required, along with the tyres
and vehicle being in good condition.
Do not activate start-off assist on public
roads.
Observe the safety notes on driving safety
systems (Y page 72).
Be sure to read the safety notes and information on ESP® (Y page 76).
Activating start-off assist
Deactivate ESP® (Y page 256).
X Turn the steering wheel to the straightahead position.
X Depress the brake pedal firmly with your
left foot and keep the brake pedal
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D.
X Use the DYNAMIC SELECT button to select
the S drive program (Y page 174).
X Quickly depress the accelerator pedal fully.
X Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
i Activate ESP® as soon as the acceleration
process has ended. ESP® will otherwise not
be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle
starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin.
X
Z
Driving and parking
When the HOLD function is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
213
Driving systems
214
Cancelling start-off assist
Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
X Reactivate ESP.
Driving and parking
X
RACE START (AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i RACE START must not be used on normal
roads. RACE START must only be activated
and used on dedicated road circuits, outside of public road use.
i RACE START is only available in
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles.
G WARNING
If you use RACE START, individual tyres may
get into a spin and the vehicle could skid.
Depending on the selected ESP® mode, there
is an increased risk of skidding and having an
accident. Make sure that no persons, animals
or obstacles are within range of the vehicle.
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. For this, a suitably highgrip road surface is required, along with the
tyres and vehicle being in good condition.
i Observe the safety notes on driving safety
systems (Y page 72).
Be sure to read the safety notes and information on ESP® (Y page 76).
Activation conditions
You can activate RACE START if:
Rthe
doors, the bonnet and the boot lid are
closed
Rthe engine is running and the transmission,
traction control and engine are at operating
temperature
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot)
Rthe
transmission is in position D
Rdrive program S, S+ or RACE is selected
(Y page 175)
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Pull and hold both steering wheel gearshift
paddles.
X The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
X Release both steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i If the activation conditions are no longer
fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START not possible See Own‐
er's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 185).
or
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 185).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal within a few seconds, RACE START is
cancelled. The multifunction display shows
the RACE START cancelled message.
X
Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed increases.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If the brake pedal is not released after a
short while, RACE START is cancelled. The
multifunction display shows the RACE
START cancelled message.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
Driving systems
Sport mode
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible or RACE START cancelled
message appears in the multifunction display.
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable
until a certain distance has been driven.
AMG RIDE CONTROL
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection of "Sport" or
"Comfort"
The suspension setting is adjusted using the
corresponding button in the centre console.
Rthe
i The mode can also be set using the AMG
DYNAMIC SELECT controller (Y page 175).
If the ignition is switched off for less than four
hours, the previously selected drive program
is activated when the engine is next started. If
the ignition is switched off for more than four
hours, Comfort mode is activated when the
engine is next started.
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
Sport mode ensures even better contact with
the road. Select this mode when employing a
sporty driving style, e.g. on winding country
roads.
X Press button : once.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected Sport mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
In Comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style, but also when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. motorways.
X Press button : again to switch off indicator lamp ;.
You have selected Comfort mode.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message appears in the multifunction display.
4MATIC
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the differential.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground or
be fully raised. Observe the instructions for
towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
Z
Driving and parking
The RACE START active message appears
in the multifunction display.
215
Driving and parking
216
Driving systems
4MATIC, together with ESP®, improves the
traction of your vehicle whenever a drive
wheel spins due to insufficient grip.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC
can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot
take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. 4MATIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time and for staying in lane.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Rwhen
pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
Raccelerate less when driving.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
you use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
Chassis with adaptive adjustable
damping
General notes
A suspension with the Adaptive Damping System provides improved driving comfort and
continuously controls the calibration of the
dampers. The damping characteristics adapt
to the current operating and driving situation.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface conditions
Rthe drive program selected
Rthe vehicle level setting
The drive program can be set using the
DYNAMIC SELECT button (Y page 174).
Rthe
Selecting Comfort mode
In the Comfort drive program, the driving
characteristics of your vehicle are more comfortable. Therefore, select this drive program
if you prefer a more comfortable driving style.
Also select the Comfort drive program when
driving fast on straight roads, e.g. on straight
stretches of motorway.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button :
(Y page 174) repeatedly until the Comfort
drive program is selected.
Selecting Sport mode
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
the Sport drive program ensures even better
contact with the road. Select this drive program when employing a sporty driving style,
e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press DYNAMIC SELECT button :
(Y page 174) repeatedly until the Sport
drive program is selected.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It monitors the area
around your vehicle using six sensors in the
front bumper and six sensors in the rear
bumper. PARKTRONIC indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars.
PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects
when they are in the immediate vicinity of
the vehicle. You could damage the vehicle
or the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause
PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
to position D, R or N on vehicles with
automatic transmission
Rrelease the electric parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
Rshift
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 344).
Range
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account
obstacles located:
Rbelow
the detection range, e.g. persons,
animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Z
217
Driving and parking
Driving systems
218
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 20 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The gear lever position or the transmission
position of the automatic transmission and
the direction in which the vehicle is rolling
determine which warning display is active
when the engine is running.
Manual transmission:
Gear lever position
Warning display
Forward gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
Reverse gear or
Rear and front areas
the vehicle is rolling activated
backwards
Automatic transmission:
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Driving systems
219
Driving and parking
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Z
220
Driving systems
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has been deactivated.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated and the
indicator lamp on the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 344).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated.
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. It measures the road on
both sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol
indicates a suitable parking space. Active
steering intervention and brake application
can assist you during parking and when exiting a parking space. You may also use
PARKTRONIC (Y page 216).
i The active braking application is only
available on vehicles with automatic transmission.
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that no persons, animals or
objects are in the manoeuvring range.
When PARKTRONIC is deactivated, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
G WARNING
While parking or pulling out of a parking
space, the vehicle swings out and can drive
onto areas of the oncoming lane. This could
cause you to collide with other road users.
There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users. Stop the
vehicle if necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at a
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Driving systems
Rparking
or stopping prohibitions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable
surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 218) warning messages during the
parking procedure
Ryou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces
that are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel.
straight roads, not bends
Ron the same level as the road, e.g. not on
the pavement
For vehicles with the trailer tow hitch folded
out, the minimum length for parking spaces is
slightly longer.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use Active Parking Assist.
Once the electrical connection is established
Ron
between your vehicle and the trailer, Active
Parking Assist is no longer available.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area.
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles.
G WARNING
If there are objects above the detection range:
RActive
Park Assist may steer too early
vehicle may not stop in front of these
objects
This could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop and deactivate Active Parking
Assist.
Rthe
For further information on the detection
range (Y page 217).
Active Parking Assist does not assist you
parking in spaces at right angles to the direction of travel if:
Rtwo
parking spaces are located directly
next to one another
Rthe parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a low kerb
Ryou forward park
Active Parking Assist does not assist you
parking in spaces that are parallel or at right
angles to the direction of travel if:
Rthe
parking space is on a kerb
system reads the parking space as
being blocked, for example by foliage or
grass paving blocks
Rthe area is too small for the vehicle to
manoeuvre into
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle, e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer
Rthe
Z
Driving and parking
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
221
Driving and parking
222
Driving systems
Example: parking symbol
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
are parallel to the direction of travel
and are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel
and at least 1.0 m longer than your vehicle
Rthat are at right angles to the direction of
travel and at least 1.0 m wider than your
vehicle
Rthat
by pressing the a button on the multifunction steering wheel. The system automatically determines whether the parking
space is parallel or at right angles to the direction of travel.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Parking
G WARNING
If you leave the vehicle when it is only being
braked by Active Parking Assist it could roll
away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe vehicle is accelerated, e.g. by a vehicle
occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always secure it
against rolling away.
i Vehicles with automatic transmis-
sion:
When PARKTRONIC detects obstacles,
Active Parking Assist brakes automatically
during the parking process. You are responsible for braking in good time.
i Note that Active Parking Assist cannot
measure the length of a parking space if it
is at right angles to the direction of travel.
You will need to judge whether your vehicle
will fit in the parking space.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
will see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the instrument cluster. When a parking space has been detected, an arrow
towards the right or the left also appears.
Active Parking Assist only displays parking
spaces on the front-passenger side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side are
displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
driver's side is activated. When parking on the
driver's side, this must remain activated until
you confirm the use of Active Parking Assist
Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the
instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to reverse gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift into position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X
X
To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X
To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundingsmessurroundings
sage appears in the multifunction display.
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. When reversing, drive at a speed
below 10 km/h. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Active Parking Assist brakes the vehicle to
a standstill when the vehicle approaches
the rear border of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select D Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage forward
gear Observe surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to first gear while the vehicle is stationary.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select transmission position D while the
vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundingsmessurroundings
sage appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
Active Parking Assist brakes the vehicle to
a standstill when the vehicle approaches
the front border of the parking space.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select R Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage reverse
gear Observe surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears and a warning tone sounds. The
vehicle is now parked.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
vehicle is kept stationary without the driver
having to depress the brake pedal. The braking effect is cancelled when you depress the
accelerator pedal.
Active Parking Assist no longer supports you
with steering interventions and brake applications. When Active Parking Assist is finished, you must steer and brake again yourself. PARKTRONIC is still available.
Parking tips:
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
Z
223
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
Driving and parking
224
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also preselect transmission position D. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should
the transmission change take place too
early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible parking position can no longer be achieved from this position.
Exiting a parking space
In order that Active Parking Assist can support you when exiting the parking space:
Ryou need to have parked using Active Park-
ing Assist.
border of the parking space must be
high enough at the front and the rear. A
kerb stone is too small, for example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide, as the position of the vehicle must
not exceed an angle of 45° to the starting
position as it is manoeuvred into the parking space.
Ra manoeuvring distance of at least 1.0 m
must be available.
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle parallel to the direction of travel using
Active Parking Assist.
Rthe
i Vehicles with automatic transmission:
If PARKTRONIC detects obstacles, Active
Parking Assist brakes automatically whilst
the vehicle exits the parking space. You are
responsible for braking in good time.
Start the engine.
Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction
you will drive out of the parking space.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position D or R.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to forward or reverse gear.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
message appears in the multifunction display %.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To exit a parking space using Active
Parking Assist: press the a button on
the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Pull away, being ready to brake at all times.
Do not exceed a maximum speed of
approximately 10 km/h when exiting a
parking space. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop, at the latest when PARKTRONIC
sounds the continuous warning tone.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
shift the transmission to position D or R.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
depending on the message or as required,
engage forward or reverse gear.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction. The Park Assist
active Accelerate and brake
Observe surroundings message appears
in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X
Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
stop, at the latest when PARKTRONIC
sounds the continuous warning tone.
X
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and
the Park Assist switched off message
appears in the multifunction display. You will
then have to steer and merge into traffic on
your own. PARKTRONIC is still available. You
can take over the steering before the vehicle
has exited the parking space completely. This
is useful, for example, when you recognise
that it is already possible to pull out of the
parking space.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
disappears and the multifunction display
shows the Park Assist cancelled message.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer and brake again yourself.
If a system malfunction occurs, the vehicle is
braked to a standstill. To drive on, depress the
accelerator pedal again.
Reversing camera
General notes
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
X
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button
(Y page 219).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
electric parking brake is applied
position P is selected in vehicles with automatic transmission
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ÷ warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
Rtransmission
Reversing camera : is an optical parking
and manoeuvring aid. It uses guide lines to
show the area behind your vehicle in the
Audio/COMAND display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
i The text shown in the Audio/COMAND
display depends on the language setting.
The following are examples of reversing
camera displays in the Audio/COMAND
display.
See the notes on cleaning (Y page 344).
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
Z
225
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
226
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Driving and parking
Rif
the tailgate is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent bulbs or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed.
Observe the notes on cleaning
(Y page 344)
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
Rin
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
COMAND Online; see the Digital Owner's
Manual.
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown with
guide lines in the Audio 20/COMAND
Online display.
The image from the reversing camera is
available throughout the manoeuvring
process.
X
To change the function mode for vehicles with trailer tow hitch: using the
Audio 20/COMAND controller, select symbol : for the "Reverse parking" function or
symbol ; for "Coupling up a trailer".
The symbol of the selected function is highlighted.
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
Displays in the Audio 20/COMAND display
The reversing camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
reversing camera in the following locations:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the tailgate
handle
Runder
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Rthe
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the Activation by R
gear function is selected in Audio 20/
X
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
= Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC: when
PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 218),
additional measurement operational readiness indicator ; appears in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display. If the PARKTRONIC
warning displays are active or light up, warning displays : and = are also active or light
up correspondingly in the Audio 20/
COMAND Online display.
"Reverse parking" function
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (locating aid)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
Z
227
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
228
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approx-
Driving and parking
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 226).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide line :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide line : as a guide, carefully reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
: Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
: Parking space marking
; Yellow guide line for the vehicle width
including the exterior mirrors, for current
steering wheel angle (dynamic)
Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 226).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking space until yellow guide line ; reaches
parking space marking :.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and reverse carefully.
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position while the vehicle is stationary.
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steering wheel
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached
the end position.
Red guide line : is then at the end of parking space =. The vehicle is almost parallel
in the parking space.
"Coupling up a trailer" function
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the ball coupling
; Trailer drawbar locating aid
= Trailer drawbar
? Symbol for the "Coupling up a trailer"
function
A Ball coupling
Select symbol ? using the controller.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
apply to objects that are at the same level
as the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure that trailer
drawbar locating aid ; points approximately in the direction of trailer drawbar
=.
X Reverse carefully until trailer drawbar =
reaches the red guide line.
The distance between the trailer drawbar
and the red guide line is now approximately
0.30 m.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 239).
X
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide
line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m
from the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
This function is only available on vehicles with
a trailer tow hitch.
X Before coupling up a trailer, set the height
of trailer drawbar ; so that it is slightly
higher than the ball coupling.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of
trailer drawbar ;.
Z
229
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
230
Driving systems
Wide-angle function
you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
: Symbol for the wide-angle view function
; Own vehicle
= PARKTRONIC warning displays
Ryou
Select this view when you are driving out of an
exit and the view of crossing traffic is restricted, for example.
Rif
switch off the engine
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break
Ryou
Displaying the attention level
ATTENTION ASSIST
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 60 km/h to
200 km/h speed range. If ATTENTION ASSIST
detects typical indicators of fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration on the part
of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration until too late, or may not detect them at
all. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the length of the journey is less than
approximately 30 minutes
Rif the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
You can have current status information displayed in the assistance menu (Y page 255)
of the on-board computer.
X Select the assistance graphics display for
ATTENTION ASSIST using the on-board
computer (Y page 255).
The following information is displayed:
Rthe
length of the journey since the last
break
Rthe attention level determined by ATTENTION ASSIST (Attention
Attention level),
level displayed in a bar display in five levels from
high to low
Rif ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate
the attention level and cannot issue a warning, the System suspended message
appears. The bar display then changes the
display, e.g. if you are driving at a speed
below 60 km/h or above 200 km/h.
Activating ATTENTION ASSIST
X
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 257).
The system determines the attention level
of the driver depending on the setting
selected:
If Standard is selected: the sensitivity with
which the system determines the attention
level is set to normal.
If Sensitive is selected: the sensitivity is set
higher. The attention level detected by
ATTENTION ASSIST is adapted accordingly
and the driver is warned earlier.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
When ATTENTION ASSIST has been deactivated, it is automatically reactivated after the
engine has been switched off. The sensitivity
selected corresponds to the last selection
activated (standard/sensitive).
Warning in the multifunction display
If fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration are detected, a warning appears in the
multifunction display: ATTENTION ASSIST
Take a break!.
break!
In addition to the message shown in the multifunction display, you will then hear a warning tone.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Confirm the message by pressing the a
button on the steering wheel.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time that allow for adequate recuperation. If
you do not take a break and ATTENTION ASSIST still detects increasing lapses in
concentration, you will be warned again after
15 minutes at the earliest. This will only happen if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects typical
indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in
concentration.
If a warning is output in the multifunction display, a service station search is performed in
COMAND Online. You can select a service
station and navigation to this service station
will then begin. This function can be activated
and deactivated in COMAND Online.
Traffic Sign Assist
General notes
Traffic Sign Assist displays the maximum
speed permitted and overtaking restrictions
to the driver in the instrument cluster. Driving
onto a section of road in the wrong direction
triggers a warning. Traffic Sign Assist detects
traffic signs with multifunction camera :
attached at the top of the windscreen. The
data and general traffic regulations stored in
the navigation system are also used to determine the current speed limit.
If a traffic sign that is relevant to your vehicle
is passed, the display of the speed limits and
overtaking restrictions is updated.
The display can also be updated without a
visible traffic sign if:
Rthe
vehicle changes roads (e.g. motorway
exit or slip road)
Ra village or town boundary is passed which
is stored in the digital map
Rthe last traffic sign detected by the camera
has not been repeated
Z
231
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
232
Driving systems
If a sign indicating the end of a restriction
(speed limit or overtaking restriction) is
passed, the sign is displayed for five seconds.
The currently applicable traffic regulation
continues to be shown in the assistance
graphic display (Y page 255).
The camera also detects traffic signs with a
restriction indicated by an additional sign
(e.g. in wet conditions).
The traffic signs are only displayed with the
restrictions if:
Rthe
regulation must be observed with the
restriction, or
RTraffic Sign Assist is unable to determine
whether the restriction applies
If Traffic Sign Assist is unable to determine a
maximum permitted speed from any of the
available sources, no speed limit is displayed
in the instrument cluster either.
The system may be either functionally
impaired or temporarily unavailable if:
Rvisibility
is poor, e.g. due to snow, rain, fog
or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun being low in
the sky
Rthere is dirt, ice or misting on the windscreen in the vicinity of the camera
Rtraffic signs are hard to detect (dirt, ice,
snow)
Rthe traffic signs are insufficiently lit at night
Rsigns are ambiguous (e.g. traffic signs on
construction sites or in adjacent lanes)
Rthe information in the digital street map of
the navigation system is incorrect or out of
date
Activating Traffic Sign Assist
X
Activate the Traffic Sign Assist display
using the on-board computer
(Y page 256).
If you have activated the Traffic Sign Assist
display in the on-board computer, the traffic
regulations (speed limits and overtaking
restrictions) are displayed in the instrument
cluster for five seconds respectively. The
wrong-way warning and the traffic sign display for speed limits and overtaking restrictions remain active in the Assist graphic even
when the display has been deactivated.
Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all countries. In this case, display : is shown in the
multifunction display.
Instrument cluster display
Important safety notes
i The following illustrations are examples of
Traffic Sign Assist is only an aid and is not
always able to correctly display speed limits
and overtaking restrictions. Traffic signs
always have priority over the Traffic Sign
Assist display.
vehicles with colour multifunction display.
The illustrations of vehicles with black and
white multifunction display differ from
them.
i The unit for the speed limit (km/h or mph)
depends on the country in which you are
driving. It is generally neither shown on the
traffic sign nor on the instrument cluster
but must be taken into account when
observing the maximum permitted speed.
Speed limit with overtaking restriction
A maximum permitted speed of 60 km/h
(60 mph) : and an overtaking restriction ;
apply.
: Maximum permitted speed
; Additional signs for wet conditions
Speed limits in wet conditions
A maximum permitted speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) applies in wet conditions and when
Traffic Sign Assist has determined that the
restriction must be observed.
: Maximum permitted speed
; Maximum permitted speed for vehicles
for which the restriction in the additional
sign is relevant
= Additional sign for unknown restriction
Speed limit with unknown restriction
A maximum permitted speed of 80 km/h
(80 mph) and a speed limit of 60 km/h
(60 mph) with an unknown restriction apply.
End of an overtaking restriction
A maximum permitted speed of 60 km/h
(60 mph) : applies. The overtaking restriction no longer applies ;. The traffic sign for
signalling the end of an overtaking restriction
is displayed for five seconds.
Z
233
Driving and parking
Driving systems
234
Driving systems
Driving and parking
End of a speed limit
No speed limit : applies here.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles:
Rovertaken
No entry (wrong-way warning)
A warning message : is displayed in the
instrument cluster if Traffic Sign Assist
detects that you are passing a “no entry” sign
and you are driving in the wrong direction.
You will then also hear a warning tone. You
should immediately check your direction of
travel in order to avoid danger to yourself and
other road users.
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 234) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 236).
Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas on either
side of the vehicle that are not visible to the
driver with two lateral, rear-facing radar sensors. A warning display in the exterior mirrors
draws your attention to vehicles detected in
the monitored area. If you then switch on the
corresponding turn signal to change lanes,
you will also receive a visual and audible collision warning.
Blind Spot Assist supports you from a speed
of approximately 30 km/h.
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rwhen the difference in the speed of
approach and overtaking is too great
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in these situations. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is no substitute for
attentive driving. Always ensure that there is
sufficient distance to the side for other road
users and obstacles.
Radar sensors
The radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the rear bumper. Make sure
that the bumpers are free from dirt, ice or
slush. The sensors must not be covered, for
example by cycle racks or overhanging loads.
Following a severe impact or in the event of
damage to the bumpers, have the function of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist may no
longer work properly.
Monitoring range of the sensors
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle or a bicycle
Rvery wide lanes
Rnarrow lanes
Rvehicles not driving in the middle of their
lane
Rbarriers or other road boundaries
Ra
Driving systems
Warning display
: Warning display
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the picture.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if the vehicles are driving on the inner
side of their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning
always occurs when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Z
Driving and parking
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
235
Driving and parking
236
Driving systems
Activating Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that Blind Spot Assist is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 257).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Towing a trailer
If you couple up a trailer, make sure that you
have correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking the trailer lighting. Blind Spot Assist is
then deactivated. The indicator lamps in the
exterior mirrors light up yellow and the
Blind Spot Assist not available when
towing a trailer See Owner's Manual
message appears in the multifunction display.
i You can deactivate the indicator lamps in
the exterior mirrors.
To do so, you will need to deactivate Blind
Spot Assist if:
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
Rthe
engine is not running
electrical connection to the trailer
has been established
Rthe
Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of multifunc-
tion camera : attached at the top of the
windscreen. Lane Keeping Assist detects lane
markings on the road and can warn you
before you leave your lane unintentionally.
This function is available in a speed range
between 60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration through the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
identify lane markings.
In these cases, Lane Keeping Assist may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep in lane, especially if Lane
Keeping Assist alerts you.
Rnot
G WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist warning does not
return the vehicle to the original lane. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always steer, apply the brakes or accelerate
the vehicle yourself, especially if Lane Keeping Assist alerts you.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. Lane
Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front,
for vehicle speed, for braking in good time and
for staying in lane.
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane.
Towing a trailer
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
X Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer; to do so, select Standard
or Adaptive (Y page 257).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lane markings in the assistance graphics display
(Y page 255) are shown in green.
When Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signal. In this
event, the warnings are suppressed for a
certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signal. In this
event, the warnings are suppressed for a
certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system detects certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
Rthe system detects solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes
cut the corner on a bend
Towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination if it begins to swerve. The vehicle/trailer combination could even overturn.
There is a risk of an accident.
On no account should you attempt to
straighten out the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing speed. Decrease your
speed and do not countersteer. Brake if necessary.
G WARNING
If the maximum the permissible load for a carrier system is exceeded, the carrier could
come loose from the vehicle and endanger
Z
Driving and parking
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
237
238
Towing a trailer
Driving and parking
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Never exceed the permissible noseweight
when using a carrier.
Exceeding the maximum permissible noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling may cause damage to the following:
Ryour
vehicle
trailer
Rthe ball coupling
Rtrailer tow hitch
The vehicle/trailer combination could
become unstable.
If the noseweight used is lower than the minimum permissible noseweight, the vehicle/
trailer combination could also become unstable.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rthe
Rmake
sure to check the noseweight before
each journey
Ruse a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum noseweight
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
noseweight
Rdo not use a noseweight lower than the
minimum noseweight
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
The applicable permissible values, which
must not be exceeded, can be found:
Rthe
Rin
your vehicle documents
Ron the identification plates of the trailer tow
hitch and the trailer
the vehicle identification plate
If the values differ, the lowest value applies.
Ron
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates
and those for the towing vehicle under "Technical data" (Y page 412).
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Ris
heavier
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Rhas an increased braking distance
Ris affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands more sensitive steering
Rhas a larger turning circle
This can impair the vehicle's handling characteristics. Adapt your driving style accordingly. Maintain a safe distance. Drive carefully.
When towing a trailer, always adjust your
speed to the current road and weather conditions. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed for your vehicle/trailer combination.
Ris
Notes on towing a trailer
General notes
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RMercedes‑AMG
CLA 45 4MATIC
with AMG Line
When towing a trailer, set the tyre pressure on
the rear axle of the towing vehicle for the
maximum load. Further information on the
tyre pressure table in the fuel filler flap
(Y page 374).
Please note that when towing a trailer, the
following driving systems have limited availability or are not available at all.
RVehicles
RPARKTRONIC (Y
page 216)
Spot Assist (Y page 234)
The height of the ball coupling changes with
the load of the vehicle. If necessary, use a
trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
You will find fitting dimensions and loads
under "Technical data" (Y page 411).
RBlind
Driving tips
Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation (Y page 79).
The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations depends on the type of
trailer. Before beginning the journey, check
the trailer's documents to see what the maximum permitted speed is. Observe the legally
prescribed maximum speed in the relevant
country.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. See the "Technical
data" section to find out whether this applies
to your vehicle. If you utilise any of the added
maximum rear axle load when towing a trailer,
the vehicle/trailer combination may not
exceed a maximum speed of 100 km/h for
reasons concerning the operating permit.
This also applies in countries in which the
permissible maximum speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations is above 100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer and it will
consume more fuel.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. For vehicles
with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual drive program M
(Y page 185).
This also applies if you have activated cruise
control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly. If you
need additional braking, depress the brake
pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.
Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal on
downhill gradients while the manual drive
program M is temporarily activated (vehicles
with automatic transmission): the automatic
transmission may switch back to the last
active automatic drive program E or S. The
automatic transmission may shift to a higher
gear. This can reduce the engine's braking
effect.
Driving tips
If the trailer swings from side to side:
Do not accelerate.
Do not countersteer.
X Brake if necessary.
X
X
RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle in
front than when driving without a trailer.
braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then, increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradient-
RAvoid
Z
239
Driving and parking
Towing a trailer
Towing a trailer
240
Driving and parking
climbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
Folding out the ball coupling
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not correctly engaged,
the trailer can detach. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always engage the ball coupling as described.
G WARNING
X
X
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Pull out release wheel =.
Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far
as it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side panelling in the luggage compartment.
Pull the ball coupling in the direction of the
arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
The indicator lamp on the release wheel
goes out. The power socket folds down
automatically.
The multifunction display shows the
Check trailer hitch lock display message until the ball coupling is engaged.
X Remove the protective covering from the
ball coupling and store it in a safe place.
X Make sure that the ball of the ball coupling
is clean and that it is either greased or dry
(grease free), depending on the instructions for the trailer.
X
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise, the fold down and remove
cover ;.
Towing a trailer
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Position the trailer horizontally behind the
vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electric connection between
the vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is
working.
A connected trailer is only recognised when
the electrical connection is established
correctly and when the lighting system is
working properly. The function of other systems, such as ESP® or PARKTRONIC also
depends on this.
X
Folding in the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Fold the ball coupling back in if you are not
using the trailer tow hitch.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side panelling in the luggage compartment.
X Place the protective covering on the ball
coupling.
Uncoupling a trailer
G WARNING
If you uncouple a trailer with an engaged overrun brake, you could trap your hand between
the vehicle and the trailer drawbar. This poses
a risk of injury.
Do not uncouple a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise, your
vehicle could be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun brake.
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise, then fold down and remove
cover ;.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
X
Z
Driving and parking
Coupling up a trailer
241
Towing a trailer
242
X
Driving and parking
X
Pull out release wheel =.
Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far
as it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
You can find more information about fitting
the trailer electrics at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X To switch the connected power supply
on or off: turn the key to position 2 or 0
respectively (Y page 165).
Failure check for LEDs
X
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages behind the
bumper.
The indicator lamp on the release knob and
the message in the multifunction display go
out.
Trailer power supply
! You can connect accessories to the per-
manent power supply up to a maximum of
240 W.
You cannot charge a trailer battery using
the power supply.
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket is equipped with a permanent
power supply and a power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, a malfunction message may appear in the multifunction display even if there is no fault. The
reason for the error message may be that the
current has fallen below the minimum of
50 mA.
To ensure reliable operation of the failure
indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting
must be guaranteed a minimum current of
50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General notes
Trailer with 7-pin connector: you can connect to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling
using an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter
cable. Both can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Fitting the adapter
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
243
Driving and parking
Towing a trailer
Open the socket cover.
Insert the plug connector with lug : into
groove = on the socket.
X Turn bayonet connection ; clockwise to
the stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
Z
244
Useful information ............................ 246
Important safety notes ..................... 246
Displays and operation ..................... 246
Menus and submenus ...................... 249
Display messages ............................. 265
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................ 301
On-board computer and displays
245
On-board computer and displays
246
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
times.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle safely as soon as
possible. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
For an overview, see the instrument panel
illustration (Y page 32).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of the
multifunction display. In daylight, the displays
in the instrument cluster are not illuminated.
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is located on the
bottom left of the instrument cluster
(Y page 32).
X Turn the brightness control knob clockwise
or anti-clockwise.
If the light switch is set to the Ã, T or
L position, the brightness is dependent
upon the brightness of the ambient light.
Speedometer with segments
The speedometer is divided into segments
only on vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS.
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RVariable
SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 202):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 204):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front
moving more slowly than the stored speed:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
Rev counter
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The engine is limited within a range to protect
the engine when the red band is reached.
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing point.
Bear in mind that the outside temperature
display indicates the measured air temperature and not the road surface temperature.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 249).
There is a short delay before a change in outside temperature appears in the multifunction display.
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= Left control panel
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the right-hand side
(Y page 32).
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
248
Displays and operation
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
%
RBack
up the menu and menu bar
through lists
a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects the
previous or next station, when
the preset list or station list is
active, or an audio track or video
scene
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
RVehicles with Audio 20: switches
off voice-operated control of the
navigation (see manufacturer's
operating instructions)
RVehicles with COMAND Online:
switches off LINGUATRONIC
(see the separate operating
instructions)
RHides display messages or calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
RScrolls
RSelects
9
:
Press and hold:
a
%
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Right control panel
ó
with Audio 20:
Switches on voice-operated control for navigation (see manufacturer's operating instructions)
RVehicles with COMAND Online:
Switches off LINGUATRONIC
(see the separate operating
instructions)
8
RMute
W
X
RAdjusts
~
RRejects
RConfirms the selection or display
message
the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
Press and hold:
RCalls
RIn the Audio menu: selects a pre-
set list or a station list in the
desired frequency range or an
audio track or video scene using
rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
Press briefly:
RIn
RVehicles
the volume
or ends a call
the telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
Multifunction display
transmission (shifting manually)
(Y page 185)
Rj Active Parking Assist (Y page 220)
R¯ Cruise control (Y page 199)
RÈ SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 202)
R_ Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 131)
Rè ECO start/stop function
(Y page 170)
Rë HOLD function (Y page 211)
R120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Menus and submenus
: Permanent display: outside temperature
;
=
?
A
B
or speed (Y page 258)
Time
Text field
Menu bar
Drive program (Y page 178)
Transmission position (Y page 180)
Vehicles with manual transmission: the indicators in the lower part of the multifunction
display differ from those shown here.
For Mercedes-AMG vehicles, the indicators in
the lower and upper part of the multifunction
display differ from those shown here.
X To display menu bar ?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
If you do not press the buttons any longer,
menu bar ? is faded out after a few seconds.
Text field = shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
i Set the time using Audio 20 or COMAND
Online (see the separate operating instructions).
Menu overview
Using the = or ; button on the steering wheel, open the menu bar.
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 247).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 250)
RNavi menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 251)
RAudio menu (Y page 253)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 254)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 255)
RServ. menu (Y page 257)
RSettings menu (settings) (Y page 258)
RAMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
(Y page 262)
The displays for the Audio
Audio, Navi and Tel
menus may differ slightly to those in your
vehicle.
The examples given in this Owner's Manual
apply to vehicles equipped with COMAND
Online.
The following messages may appear in
the multifunction display:
RZ
Gearshift recommendation for manual
transmission (Y page 176) or for automatic
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
250
Trip menu
Standard display
When 9,999 hours or 99,999 kilometres have
been exceeded, the trip computer is automatically reset From reset.
reset
ECO display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; appears.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
The ECO display is not available in MercedesAMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ECO DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 196).
:
;
=
?
Distance
Driving time
Average speed
Average fuel consumption
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 251).
In the following cases, the trip computer is
automatically reset From start:
start
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the menu only displays range :.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the display
with approximate range : and current fuel
consumption ;.
Approximate range : that can be covered
is calculated according to your current driving style and the amount of fuel in the tank.
If there is only a small amount of fuel left in
the fuel tank, a vehicle being refuelled C
appears instead of approximate range :.
Recuperation display = shows you if
energy has been recuperated from the
kinetic energy in overrun mode and saved
in the battery. Recuperation display =
depends on the engine installed and is
therefore not available in all vehicles.
Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
digital speedometer ;.
Gearshift recommendation : Z may also
be displayed.
Observe the information on gearshift recommendation : for manual transmission
(Y page 176) or for automatic transmission
(shifting manually) (Y page 185).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: a gearshift recommendation is shown in the status bar of
the multifunction display and not in the digital speedometer display.
X
X
X
Press a to confirm.
Press : to select Yes and press a to
confirm.
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip
meter
start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
If you reset the values in the "ECO display",
the values in the "From start" trip computer
are also reset. If you reset the values in the
"From start" trip computer, the values in the
"ECO display" are also reset.
R"From
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions.
Further information on navigation can be
found in the separate Audio 20 or COMAND
Online operating instructions.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online;
see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
Route guidance not active
Resetting values
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
252
Menus and submenus
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
:
;
=
?
Distance to the destination
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Symbol indicating "follow the road's
course"
Change of direction without lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is to be made, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. This shortens
towards the top of the display as you
approach the point of the announced change
of direction. The change of direction starts
once the distance display reaches zero.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Lanes not recommended
? Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction
A Change-of-direction symbol
On multilane roads, new lane recommendations can be displayed for the next change of
direction if the digital map supports this data.
During the change of direction, new lanes
may be added.
Lane not recommended =: you will not be
able to complete the next change of direction
if you stay in this lane.
Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction ?: in this lane you will be
able to complete the next two changes of
direction without changing lane.
Other status indicators of the navigation system
The navigation system displays additional
information and the vehicle status.
Possible displays
RNew
route... or Calculating route...
A new route is calculated.
not mapped
The vehicle position is inside the area of the
digital map but the road is not recognised,
e.g. new roads, car parks or private land.
RNo route
No route could be calculated to the selected destination.
RO
You have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
Audio player or audio media operation
RRoad
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Active station list
; Station with preset position
The multifunction display shows station ;
with station frequency or station name. The
preset position is only displayed along with
station ; if this has been stored.
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online and
select Radio (see the separate operating
instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a preset list or station list:
press and briefly hold the 9 or :
button until the preset list or station list in
the desired frequency range is shown.
X To select a station: briefly press 9
or :.
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcast-
: Current track
Audio files from various audio players or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online and
select audio CD or MP3 mode (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until the desired track
appears.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button, the rapid scrolling speed is
increased. Not all audio players or media
support this function.
X
If track information is stored on the audio
player or media, the multifunction display will
show the number and title of the track.
Video DVD operation
Only for vehicles with COMAND Online: you
can use the Audio menu to play video DVDs.
ing) is an optimised digital transmission
standard designed for the mobile reception
of radio transmissions.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
254
Switch on COMAND Online and select
video DVD (see the separate operating
instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene :
appears.
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service:
service there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rat
Telephone menu
Introduction
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone (see the manufacturer's operating instructions).
X Switch on Audio 20 or COMAND Online;
see the separate operating instructions.
X Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 329).
or
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to Audio
20 or COMAND Online; see the separate
operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call at any time, even if you
are not in the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
Rejecting or ending a call
You can reject or end a call any time even if
you are not in the Tel menu.
X Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel to reject or end an incoming call.
Selecting an entry in the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Authorise access to the phone book on the
phone.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
or
X To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold
the 9 or : button for longer than
one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X
X
Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X
If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
Assistance menu
Introduction
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you have the following options in the
Assist. menu:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 255)
RActivating/deactivating the Traffic Sign
Assist message function (Y page 256)
RActivating/deactivating ESP® (except
Mercedes-AMG vehicles) (Y page 256)
RActivating/deactivating COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS (Y page 256)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 257)
RActivating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 257)
RActivating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 257)
Showing the assistance graphic
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
256
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assistance
graphic.
graphic
X Press a to confirm.
The multifunction display shows the
DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the
assistance graphic.
The assistance graphic shows you the status of and/or information from the following driving systems or driving safety systems:
RTraffic Sign Assist (Y page 231)
RDISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 204)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(Y page 73)
RATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 230)
RLane Keeping Assist (Y page 236)
RRear window wiper (Y page 138)
X Press : to display the ATTENTION ASSIST assessment.
X
Traffic Sign Assist
In the Traffic Sign Assist menu, you can
switch the Traffic Sign Assist message function on or off. When the message function is
activated, detected traffic signs and information appear in the multifunction display for
five seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Traffic Sign Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate the message
function: press a again.
Further information about Traffic Sign Assist
(Y page 231).
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Observe the important safety notes on ESP®
(Y page 77).
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Deactivating/activating ESP® on MercedesAMG vehicles (Y page 78).
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 76).
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select ESP
ESP.
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up
continuously when the engine is running.
Rin
If the ÷ and å warning lamps light up
continuously, ESP® is not available due to a
malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 306).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 266).
Activating/deactivating COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Collision Prevent. Assist.
Assist
X
Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS is deactivated, the æ symbol
appears in the multifunction display in the
assistance graphic display.
X
For further information about COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, see (Y page 73).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Sensitive
Sensitive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated,
the é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
X
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 230).
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
X
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keeping Assist.
Assist
X Press a to confirm.
The current selection appears.
X Press a again to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Lane Keeping Assist is activated, the
multifunction display shows the lane markings as bright lines in the assistance
graphic.
X
For further information about Lane Keeping
Assist, see (Y page 236).
Service menu
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you have the following options in the
Serv. menu:
RCalling up display messages in the message memory (Y page 265)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning
system (Y page 376)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 340)
Further information about Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 234).
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
258
Menus and submenus
Settings menu
Introduction
Rcurrent fuel consumption and approximate
range
Rnavigation
instructions in the Navi menu
control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rcruise
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, In the Settings menu you have the
following options:
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
RChanging the light settings
RChanging the vehicle settings
RChanging the heating settings
RChanging the convenience settings
RRestoring the factory settings
Instrument cluster
Selecting the distance unit
The Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in
the multifunction display.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to the:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rtotal
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
If the additional speedometer is switched on,
the speed is shown in the status bar of the
multifunction display instead of the outside
temperature.
The speed display is inverse to your speedometer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dig. speedo [mph] function.
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Selecting permanent display
United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
The Permanent display: function allows
you to choose whether the multifunction display always shows the outside temperature or
the speed.
The speed display is inverse to your speedometer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display: function.
The current setting, outside tempera‐
ture or Dig. speedo [mph]:,
[mph]: appears.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Lights
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light System function.
If the Intell. Light Sys. function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you switch Intell. Light System
function on, you activate the following functions:
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering light function
RExtended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Intell. Light System:
system inoperative Inactive for
left-side traffic or Intell. Light
System: System inoperative Inactive
for right-side traffic display message
instead of the Intell. Light System function in the Lights submenu.
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 130).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
This function is only available in vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 126).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
The current setting Right-side traffic
or Left-side traffic appears.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable. These are only deactivated if the
setting for driving on the left/right is set
opposite to your vehicle's country version.
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the
left/right.
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can set permanent SPEEDTRONIC using
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (160
160 km/h to 240 km/h).
km/h The Off set-
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
260
Menus and submenus
ting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 204).
Activating/deactivating the automatic
locking feature
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door locks function.
If the Automatic door locks function is
switched on, the multifunction display
shows the doors in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of around 15 km/h.
For further information on the automatic locking feature; see (Y page 95).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the
vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Heating
Auxiliary heating departure time
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Only vehicles with auxiliary heating have this
function.
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the set air conditioning or
THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Further information on auxiliary heating
(Y page 156).
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The current setting appears.
X Press a again.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The current setting appears.
Press the : or 9 button to select
Change A,
A Change B or Change C.
C
X Press a to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
X
Comfort
Switching belt adjustment on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is
activated, the seat belt is displayed in
orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 47).
Switching the fold mirrors in when locking function on/off
This function is only available when the vehicle is equipped with the electrical fold-in function.
When you activate the Auto. fold-in mir‐
rors function, the exterior mirrors are folded
in when the vehicle is locked. When you
unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's
or front-passenger door, the exterior mirrors
fold out again.
If you have switched on the Auto. fold-in
mirrors function and you fold in the exterior
mirrors using the button on the door
(Y page 120), they will not fold out automat-
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
262
ically. The exterior mirrors can then only be
folded out using the button on the door.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold-in mirrors function.
If the Auto. fold-in mirrors function is
switched on, the multifunction display
shows the exterior mirror in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? function
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu.
AMG menu (Mercedes-AMG vehicles)
WARMUP
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Transmission oil temperature
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator: upshift indicator UP =
indicates that the engine has reached the
overrevving range when in the manual drive
program.
Engine and transmission oil temperature: when the engine and transmission
are at normal operating temperature, oil
temperature ? and B are displayed in
white in the multifunction display.
If the multifunction display shows oil temperature ? or B in blue, the engine or the
transmission are not yet at normal operating temperature. Avoid using the full output
of the engine during this time.
SETUP
: Drive system Comfort
Comfort/Sport
Sport/Sport
Sport +
; Suspension Comfort
Comfort/Sport
Sport/Sport
Sport +
= Transmission D/M
M
? ESP® On
On/Off
Off or SPORT handling mode
Displaying the intermediate time
Sport
SETUP displays the following information and
functions:
Rthe
digital speedometer
gear indicator
Rthe drive system setting
Rthe suspension mode
Rthe transmission position
Rthe ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) status
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press 9 repeatedly until SETUP
appears.
Rthe
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is shown for five seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
i A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The
: Lap
; RACETIMER
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position 2
in the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER appears.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
16th lap can only be completed with Fin‐
ish Lap.
Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
X
Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X Confirm Yes with a.
X
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop
the vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in
the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position
Z
263
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
264
Menus and submenus
3 and then press a to confirm Start
Start, timing is continued.
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Resetting the current lap
X Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation appears.
Lap evaluation
Deleting all laps
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Overall evaluation
:
;
=
?
A
RACETIMER overall evaluation
Total time driven
Average speed
Distance covered
Maximum speed
:
;
=
?
A
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until a lap
evaluation appears.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
X
Display messages
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, these display messages are deleted as well.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD
function (Y page 211)
page 192)
RParking (Y
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
The multifunction display hides the display message.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
266
Display messages
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), BAS (Brake Assist System), ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program), ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD
function, hill start assist and PRE-SAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the !, ÷ and å warning lamps may light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
RSelf-diagnosis
RThe
is not yet complete
on-board voltage may be insufficient.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
ABS, BAS, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and PRE-SAFE® are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
The !, ÷, å and J warning lamps may also light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start
assist and PRE-SAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps may light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
268
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start
assist and PRE-SAFE® are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps may light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
T!
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, BAS, ESP®, ESP®
trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill start assist and PRESAFE® are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
A warning tone sounds.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps may light up
in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition was switched off.
X Key: turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: switch on the ignition.
!
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 193).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release
the parking brake
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking
brake (Y page 193).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
Press the electric parking brake lever for at least ten seconds.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
270
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are
lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
or
Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release): insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric
parking brake automatically (Y page 193).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
Do not drive on.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 381).
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to position P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release): insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric
parking brake automatically (Y page 193).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to
apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: switch off the ignition.
The electric parking brake is applied automatically.
or
X Insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate slightly
more when pulling away (automatic emergency release).
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to position P, as the electric parking brake is not applied automatically.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If you do not wish the electric parking brake to be applied, leave the
ignition switched on, e.g. when washing the vehicle in an automatic car wash or when having the vehicle towed.
Z
271
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
272
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
Parking brake inop‐ has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
erative
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by
charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is still not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to position P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
J
Brake immediately
Vehicles with manual transmission: a malfunction has occurred
while the HOLD function was activated.
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. If you attempt to lock
the vehicle, the tone becomes louder.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
You can restart the engine.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
G
One or more main features of the Mercedes-Benz Contact system
are malfunctioning.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Check brake pad
wear
Inoperative
Rthe
radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Restart the engine.
X
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
inoperative
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is temporarily inoperative
due to a malfunction. Adaptive Brake Assist may also have failed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
273
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
274
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
PRE-SAFE inopera‐
tive See Owner's
Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Radar sensors
dirty See Owner's
Manual
At least one of the following driving systems or driving safety systems is temporarily restricted or inoperative:
RCOLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
PLUS
Possible causes:
RDISTRONIC
Rthe sensors in the radiator trim and/or in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe function of the driving system and/or driving safety system
is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out. All driving systems and driving safety systems are operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Switch off the engine.
X Clean the sensors (Y page 344) in the following locations:
Rin the radiator trim
Rin the front bumper
Rin the rear bumper, particularly in the middle of the rear
bumper
X Restart the engine.
The display message disappears.
X
ü
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 48).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ý
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been
engaged in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts (Y page 46).
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 48).
6
The restraint system is faulty. The 6 warning lamp also lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
For further information about the restraint system, see
(Y page 42).
6
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the front on the left or
right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusFront left malfunc‐ ter.
tion Consult work‐
G WARNING
shop or Front
right malfunction
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintenConsult workshop
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
The rear left-hand or right-hand restraint system has malfunctioned. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument
cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
275
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
276
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The left or right windowbag is malfunctioning. The 6 warning
lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Left windowbag mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop or Right
The left or right windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally
windowbag malfunc‐ or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
tion Consult work‐ This poses an increased risk of injury.
shop
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front passenger
airbag disabled
See Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is disabled during the journey
although:
Ran
adult
or
Ra person of the corresponding stature is on the front-passenger
seat
If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the system
detects may be too low.
G WARNING
The front-passenger front airbag does not deploy during an accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Have the occupant on the front-passenger seat step out of the
vehicle.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the frontpassenger door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Ra
self-diagnosis takes place. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
and PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds
Rthe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up
and remain on after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is
on, the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
system has disabled the front-passenger front airbag
(Y page 52)
Rthe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's
Manual or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Own‐
er's Manual display messages must not be shown in the
multifunction display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator
Z
277
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
278
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 51).
Front-passenger
airbag enabled See
Owner's Manual
The front-passenger front airbag is enabled during the journey
although:
Ra child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system
weight threshold is located on the front-passenger seat
or
Rthe front-passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are adding to the
weight applied to the seat.
G WARNING
The airbag may deploy unintentionally.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat.
X Make sure there are no objects applying additional force to the
seat.
The system may otherwise detect the additional force and interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually is.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied, close the frontpassenger door and switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps in the centre
console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Ra
self-diagnosis takes place. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
and PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds
Rthe PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up
and remain on after the self-diagnosis. If the indicator lamp is
on, the automatic front-passenger front airbag deactivation
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
system has disabled the front-passenger front airbag
(Y page 52)
Rthe Front-passenger airbag enabled See Owner's
Manual or Front-passenger airbag disabled See Own‐
er's Manual display messages must not be shown in the
multifunction display
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF or ON indicator
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how the automatic frontpassenger front airbag deactivation system classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Further information on the automatic front-passenger front airbag
deactivation feature (Y page 51).
Lights
i Vehicles with LED light bulbs in the light clusters:
The display message for the corresponding lamp only appears when all the LEDs in the lamp
have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
Left cornering
(Y page 133).
light or Right cor‐
or
nering light
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
279
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
280
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
Trailer left tail
lamporTrailer
lamp
Trailer
right tail lamp
b
Trailer left turn
signalorTrailer
signal
Trailer
right turn signal
b
Trailer brake lamp
b
Rear left indica‐
tor or Rear right
indicator
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions.
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
tor or Right mir‐
ror indicator
b
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Third brake lamp
Left brake
lamporRight
lamp
Right brake
lamp
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
b
Left main beam or
Right main beam
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left- or right-hand foglamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Number plate lamp
Left fog
lamporRight
lamp
Right fog
lamp
Rear foglamp
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
Reversing light
Left tail lamp or
Right tail lamp
Z
281
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
282
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 133).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
The exterior lighting is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Check the fuses (Y page 367).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to the à position.
b
You are driving without dipped-beam headlamps.
X Turn the light switch to the L or à position.
Switch off lights
Switch on headlamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message is
displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
X
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 338).
If you have to top up the coolant frequently:
X
?
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine
cooling system checked.
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Z
283
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
284
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Wait until the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
If the temperature increases again:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
#
See Owner's Manual
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
Rtorn
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is no longer being charged and the battery charge level
is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Observe the instructions in the # See Owner's Manual
display message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
Stop vehicle See
Owner's Manual
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 336).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 337).
X
If the engine oil needs topping up more often:
X
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine
checked.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
Add 1 litre engine ! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
oil when next refu‐
elling
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 336).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 337).
If the engine oil needs topping up more often:
X
Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the engine
checked.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Z
285
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
286
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
4
The engine oil level is too low. There is a risk of engine damage.
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Check the engine oil level (Y page 336).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 337).
æ
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ç
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
Engine oil level
Stop vehicle
Switch engine off
Reserve fuel level
X
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 211).
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 211).
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthere have been no lane markings for an extended period
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rvisibility
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
287
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
288
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Restart the engine.
X
Active Blind Spot
Assist not availa‐
ble when towing a
trailer See Own‐
er's Manual.
Manual
Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while towing a trailer.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer
and your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative
Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
led
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 220).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately ten minutes (Y page 220).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist
switched off
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
Traffic Sign
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Traffic Sign Assist is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Traffic Sign Assist is operational again.
Traffic Sign
Assist inoperative
Traffic Sign Assist is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 204).
If it was not deactivated by the driver, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 204).
Z
289
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
290
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
rently unavailable Possible causes:
See Owner's Manual
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty. Adaptive Brake Assist may also have
failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS sus‐ You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
pended
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
- - - km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 204).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
SPEEDTRONIC sus‐
pended
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC is switched to passive mode.
The speed limitation is not active.
X Drive slower than the stored speed and without kickdown.
X Call up the last speed stored again.
or
X Set a new speed.
When the display message disappears, the speed limitation is
active.
Cruise control
- - - km/h
RA
condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
RESP® is deactivated The yellow ESP® OFF warning lamp is lit.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
or
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 199).
or
X Reactivate ESP® (Y page 256).
120 km/h!
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!.
km/h!
X Drive more slowly.
Z
291
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
292
Display messages
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted
new wheels and tyres
tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped
Rthe
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 352).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 376).
Check tyre pres‐
sures then restart
Run Flat Indicator
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
Rectify tyre pres‐
sure
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 376).
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 376).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 378).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position appears in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 352).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 376).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning tyre defect The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position appears in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 352).
Ryou
Z
293
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
294
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. moni‐
tor currently
unavailable
No signals can be received from the tyre pressure sensors due to
strong RF interference. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Depress brake to
start engine
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position N without depressing the brake pedal.
X
To shift out of P
or N, depress
brake and start
engine
Depress the brake pedal.
You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R or D
without starting the engine.
X Start the engine.
X Depress the brake pedal.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission from position P to
the desired position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then
can the parking lock be deactivated. If you do not depress the
brake pedal, the DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but the
parking lock remains engaged.
i At transmission fluid temperatures below Ò20 † you can only
shift out of position P into another transmission position when
the engine is running.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Apply brake to
deselect Park (P)
position
You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R, N or D
without depressing the brake pedal.
X Depress the brake pedal.
Risk of vehicle
rolling Transmis‐
sion not in P
The driver's door is open or not fully closed and the transmission
is in position R, N or D.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The vehicle may roll away.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Close the driver's door fully.
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
Without changing
gear, consult work‐ A warning tone also sounds.
shop
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
X
Only select Park
(P) when vehicle
is stationary
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning. You cannot drive in
Reversing not
poss. Consult work‐ reverse.
shop
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Mal‐
function
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Mal‐
function Stop
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
295
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
296
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Stop vehicle Shift
to P Leave engine
running
The automatic transmission has overheated.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the automatic transmission
is available again.
If the multifunction display still shows the display message:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Wait until the automatic transmission has cooled down and the
display message goes out.
X
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer
being charged.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Until then, set the transmission to position P before you switch
off the engine.
X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
Clutch overheated
Avoid pulling away
If necessary,
quickly release
and engage the
clutch
The clutch is under considerable load and the permitted operating
temperature has been exceeded. A warning tone also sounds.
Avoid frequent pulling away and driving at walking pace over longer distances.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Leave the engine running.
The clutch is cooled more quickly with the engine running.
or
X If possible, continue driving at a steady speed.
X Remove your foot from the clutch pedal and do not allow the
clutch to slip.
The clutch may also cool down during the journey.
It may take several minutes for it to cool down. When the clutch
has cooled down, the display message disappears. The clutch is
fully operational again.
For engine start
depress clutch
You have attempted to start the engine without depressing the
clutch pedal.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Restart the engine.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine has stalled while pulling away, e.g. because the clutch
pedal was released too quickly.
X Depress the clutch pedal again.
The engine starts automatically.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal to pull away.
Trans. oil overhea‐ Mercedes-AMG vehicles: the transmission oil has overheated.
ted Drive on with
Manual drive program M and the temporarily active manual drive
care
program are no longer available. Engine power output is reduced.
X Allow the vehicle to cool down.
4matic currently
unavailable
4MATIC has overheated. The vehicle is only driven by the front
wheels.
X Drive on.
The airflow cools 4MATIC more quickly.
When the display message goes out, 4MATIC is available again
and the vehicle is driven by all four wheels.
4matic inoperative
4MATIC is malfunctioning. The vehicle is only driven by the front
wheels.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
A
The tailgate is open.
G WARNING
When the engine is running, exhaust gases can enter the vehicle
interior if the tailgate is open.
There is a risk of poisoning.
X Close the tailgate.
?
The bonnet is open.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Close the bonnet.
Z
297
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
298
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a
malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
j
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Check trailer
hitch lock
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not engaged, the trailer may come loose.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Engage the trailer coupling's ball coupling in the end position
(Y page 240).
&
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 156).
X Drive for a considerable distance.
The battery charges. The auxiliary heating is operational again as
soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
&
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on (Y page 156).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
&
The auxiliary heating is temporarily malfunctioning or faulty.
If the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled down:
inoperative Bat‐
tery Low
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
X
Make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating,
waiting several minutes between each attempt (Y page 156).
If the auxiliary heating does not switch on:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
If you are able to steer safely:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
If you are unable to steer safely:
X
X
Ð
Steering malfunc‐
tion See Owner's
Manual
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The electric steering lock is malfunctioning.
G WARNING
The steering may be locked by the electric steering lock.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Do not drive on.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
_
The electric steering lock was unable to unlock the steering.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Before starting
X To unlock the steering, move the steering wheel slightly.
the engine, turn
the steering wheel. X Insert the key into the ignition lock again.
Telephone No ser‐
vice
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 339).
Z
299
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
300
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Wiper malfunction‐
ing
The windscreen wipers are defective.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard warning
lamps malfunction‐
ing
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
The key needs to be replaced.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Â
The key battery is discharged.
X Replace the battery (Y page 90).
Â
The key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Locate the key.
Change key batter‐
ies
Key not detected
(red display message)
Because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves,
the key is not detected whilst the engine is running.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and bring into key mode.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The key is currently undetected.
X Change the location of the key in the vehicle.
Key not detected
(white display message)
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
If the key still cannot be detected:
X
Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
The key is continually undetected.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
General notes
Some systems perform a self test when the ignition is switched on. Some warning and indicator
lamps may temporarily switch on or flash during the test. This behaviour is nothing to be
concerned about.
The warning and indicator lamps will alert you to a malfunction if they switch on or flash after
the engine is started or while driving.
Safety
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
Only for certain coun- to fasten their seat belts.
tries: the red seat belt X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
warning lamp lights up
for 6 seconds after the
engine starts.
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Only for certain coun- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
tries: the red seat belt
The warning tone ceases.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
6 seconds.
Z
301
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
302
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
The red seat belt warn- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
ing lamp lights up after
The warning lamp goes out.
the engine starts, as
soon as the driver's or There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
the front-passenger
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
door is closed.
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the
The red seat belt warn- same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
ing lamp flashes and an driven faster than 25 km/h.
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
G WARNING
The red brake system The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking charwarning lamp is lit while acteristics may be affected.
the engine is running. A
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
sounds.
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
the engine is running. A Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Z
303
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
304
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) has been deactivated due to a
fault. Therefore, BAS (Brake Assist System), COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), ESP®
trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE®, for example, are also deactivated.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, EBD
(electronic brake force distribution), the HOLD function, hill start
assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE®, for example, are
also deactivated.
Possible causes:
RSelf-diagnosis
is not yet complete
RThe on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
Z
305
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
306
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION
ASSIST PLUS, ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, the HOLD function,
hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and PRE‑SAFE®, for
example, are also not available.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
!֌J
The red brake system
warning lamp and the
yellow ABS, ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
drive system is running.
ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning. Therefore, BAS, COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function,
hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are also not available.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
The yellow ESP® warn- skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
ing lamp flashes while Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 78) it may be best to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 77).
å
ESP® is deactivated. ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle if it starts
®
to
skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
The yellow ESP OFF
warning lamp is lit while G WARNING
the engine is running.
If ESP® is deactivated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
Further driving systems or driving safety systems are thus restricted.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
Reactivate ESP®.
In rare cases (Y page 78) it may be best to deactivate ESP®.
Observe the important safety notes on ESP® (Y page 77).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have ESP®
checked.
M
Mercedes-AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Only switch to SPORT handling mode in accordance with the
conditions described in the "Activating/deactivating ESP®" section (Y page 78).
Z
307
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
308
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®,ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION
ASSIST PLUS, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive
brake lights and PRE‑SAFE® are not available due to a malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, ESP® trailer stabilisation, BAS, the HOLD function, hill start
assist and PRE-SAFE® are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS may also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red indicator lamp
for the electric parking
brake flashes or is lit
and/or the yellow
warning lamp for the
electric parking brake
is lit.
X
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
6
The restraint system is faulty.
The red restraint sysG WARNING
tem warning lamp is lit
while the engine is run- The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
ning.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Contact a qualified specialist workshop and have the restraint
system checked.
For further information about the restraint system, see
(Y page 42).
Z
309
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
310
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be
running in emergency mode.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
(Y page 191).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
æ
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
warning lamp is on
drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may
be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 338).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is
below 120 †. The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
Z
311
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
312
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 338).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
For further information on the distance warning function of COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, see (Y page 73).
Tyres
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) is lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) flashes for
approximately one
minute and then
remains lit.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 192).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 352).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 376).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to detect or register low tyre pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
313
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
314
315
Useful information ............................ 316
Loading guidelines ............................ 316
Stowage areas ................................... 316
Stowing and features
Features ............................................. 325
316
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. If the tailgate
is open when the engine is running, particularly if the vehicle is moving, exhaust fumes
could enter the passenger compartment.
There is a risk of poisoning.
Turn off the engine before opening the tailgate. Never drive with the tailgate open.
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rnever
exceed the maximum permissible
gross vehicle weight or the permissible axle
loads for the vehicle (including occupants).
Rthe luggage compartment is the preferred
place to carry objects.
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the load compartment as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Ruse the lashing eyelets and the luggage
nets to transport loads and luggage.
Ronly use lashing eyelets and fastening components that are suitable for the weight and
size of the load.
Rhook in the safety net when loading.
Rthe maximum load capacity of the stowage
well under the luggage compartment floor
is 25 kg.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. pad sharp
edges for protection.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
Stowage areas
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 316).
Front stowage compartments
Glove compartment
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
There is a pen holder at the top of the glove
compartment flap.
Spectacles compartment
X
To open: press marking :.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment
is always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Stowage compartment in the front centre
console
Illustration: vehicles with DIRECT SELECT
lever
X
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an ashtray in the centre console instead of the stowage compartment.
Z
Stowing and features
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces before
starting a journey.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the luggage compartment.
317
Stowage areas
318
Stowage compartment in front of the armrest (vehicles with automatic transmission)
an iPod®, iPhone® or MP3 player; see the
separate operating instructions
Ra mobile phone bracket (Y page 329)
Stowage compartment under the driver's
and front-passenger seat
Stowing and features
G WARNING
Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
X
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i You can remove the non-slip mat and the
insert for cleaning. When removing the
insert you will have to overcome some
slight resistance.
If you exceed the maximum permitted load of
the stowage compartment, the cover is
unable to restrain the objects. Objects may be
thrown out of the stowage compartment and
hit vehicle occupants as a result. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always observe the maximum load of the
stowage compartment. Stow and secure
heavy objects in the luggage compartment.
The maximum permissible load of the stowage compartment is 1.2 kg.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
X
To open: on vehicles with moveable armrests, make sure that the armrest is in the
rearmost position.
X Press button : and fold the armrest up.
X
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the
armrest can be moved backwards or forwards
in a longitudinal direction.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
following may be in the stowage space:
Ra
multimedia connector unit with an SD
card slot and 2 USB ports, e.g. for use with
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
On vehicles with a fire extinguisher instead of
a stowage compartment, the fire extinguisher
is installed under the driver's seat.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartment in the rear centre
console
Through-loading facility in the rear
compartment
X
X
To open: pull down the top of stowage
compartment : by the edge of the handle.
X
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
To open: fold down seat armrest :.
Pull the centre head restraint on the rear
bench seat into the uppermost position
(Y page 115).
there may be an open stowage space above
the stowage compartment.
Luggage nets
Luggage nets are located:
Rin
the front-passenger footwell
the back of the driver's and frontpassenger seat
Ron the left and right-hand side in the luggage compartment
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 316)
and the safety notes regarding stowage
spaces (Y page 316).
Ron
Slide locking mechanism = in the direction of the arrow.
X Swing flap ; fully to the side.
Flap ; is held open by a magnet.
X
To close: swing flap ; in the luggage compartment back until it engages.
X Fold armrest : up fully if necessary.
X
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 316).
Enlarging the luggage compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forZ
Stowing and features
Rear stowage compartments
319
Stowage areas
Stowing and features
320
wards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot/luggage compartment cannot be restrained by the seat
backrest.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle ; of the seat backrest forwards.
The corresponding seat backrest : is
released.
X Fold backrest : forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Folding the rear seat backrest back
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
! Before folding the backrest in the rear
compartment forwards, make sure that the
rear compartment armrest and the
cupholder are folded in. They may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 316).
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded forwards separately to
increase the luggage compartment capacity.
Folding the rear seat backrest forwards
and back
Folding the rear seat backrest forward
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
Red lock status indicator ; is no longer
visible.
X Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 116).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Adjusting the angle of the rear seat backrests (cargo position)
If necessary, press the backrest head
restraints down fully (Y page 116).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X
Stowage areas
Fold the seat backrest forward
(Y page 320).
X Move handle : in the direction of the
arrow.
X Push back seat backrest ; as far as handle : until the backrest engages.
The backrest is now in the cargo position.
X
Bag hook
G WARNING
The bag hooks cannot restrain heavy objects
or items of luggage. Objects or items of luggage could be flung around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants when braking or abruptly
changing directions. There is a risk of injury.
Only hang light objects on the bag hooks.
Never hang hard, sharp-edged or fragile
objects on the bag hooks.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load of
Securing a load
3 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
Lashing eyelets
General notes
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Robserve
the loading guidelines
(Y page 316).
Rsecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
Rdistribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
Rdo not use elastic straps or nets to secure a
load. These are only intended as an anti-slip
protection for light loads.
Rdo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
Rpad sharp edges for protection.
Luggage compartment
: Lashing eyelets
: Bag hook
Luggage compartment cover
Important safety notes
G WARNING
On its own, the luggage compartment cover
cannot secure or restrain heavy objects,
items of luggage and heavy loads. You could
be hit by an unsecured load during sudden
changes in direction, braking or in the event of
an accident. There is an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using lashing material, even if you are using
the luggage compartment cover.
! When loading the vehicle, make sure that
you do not stack the load in the luggage
Z
Stowing and features
Vehicles with luggage compartment package:
to enlarge the luggage compartment, you can
adjust the rear seat backrests to a 15°
steeper angle (cargo position).
321
Stowage areas
322
compartment higher than the lower edge of
the side windows. Do not place heavy
objects on top of the luggage compartment
cover.
Stowing and features
The luggage compartment cover is located
behind the rear bench seat backrest.
Extending and retracting the luggage
compartment cover
To extend: pull luggage compartment
cover : towards you by grab handle ;
until it engages.
X To retract: push the rear edge of luggage
compartment cover : downward.
Luggage compartment cover : automatically moves forward.
X
To remove: make sure that the luggage
compartment cover is rolled up.
X Push in the end cap of luggage compartment cover : in the direction of the arrow
on the right or left-hand side using grip =
on the lower edge.
X Push luggage compartment cover : into
opposite anchorage ;.
X Remove luggage compartment cover :
upwards.
X To fit: place luggage compartment
cover : into anchorage ; on the right or
left-hand side.
X Push in the opposite end cap of luggage
compartment cover : and insert luggage
compartment cover : into opposite
anchorage ;.
X
Stowing the luggage compartment
cover
The luggage compartment cover can be folded up to make loading easier.
Fitting/removing the luggage compartment cover
The luggage compartment cover can be
stored in the stowage well underneath the
luggage compartment floor.
X
Open the luggage compartment floor and
hang the hook from the luggage compartment floor on the upper seal of the luggage
compartment (Y page 324).
Press luggage compartment cover : into
the luggage compartment side trim panel
opening and push forward.
X Press the luggage compartment cover further and push it into luggage compartment
lip opening ;.
X
Stowage areas
323
Safety net
G WARNING
On its own, the safety net cannot secure or
restrain heavy objects, items of luggage and
heavy loads. You could be hit by an unsecured
load during sudden changes in direction,
braking or in the event of an accident. There is
an increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using lashing material, even if you are using
the safety net.
It is important to use a safety net if you load
the vehicle with small objects above the seat
backrests. For safety reasons, always use a
safety net when transporting a load.
Damaged safety nets can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Attaching and tightening the safety net
You have two options for hooking in the safety
net:
Rwith
luggage compartment enlargement:
the brackets are behind the B‑pillar and the
lashing eyelets to tension the net are on the
sides of the rear-compartment footwell.
Rwithout luggage compartment enlargement: the brackets are behind the C-pillar
and the lashing eyelets to tension the net
are in the luggage compartment
(Y page 321).
The safety net is located in the stowage space
under the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 324).
X Open both Velcro fasteners and remove the
safety net.
X Unroll and unfold the safety net.
The joints on the upper and lower guide rod
should engage audibly.
Safety net (with luggage compartment enlargement)
Safety net (without luggage compartment enlargement)
To attach and tighten: insert guide rod :
into bracket ;.
X Attach belt hook ? to the lashing eyelet
and pull down on the loose end of the lashing strap until the safety net is taut.
X After driving a short distance, check the
tension of the safety net and retighten it if
necessary.
X To loosen and detach: pull belt clamp =
up to reduce the tension in the lashing
strap.
X Unhook belt hook ? from the lashing eyelet.
X Detach guide rod : from bracket ;.
X To stow: press the red button on the upper
and lower guide rod.
X Fold the safety net and roll it up.
X Close the two Velcro fasteners on the
safety net holder.
X
Z
Stowing and features
Important safety notes
Stowage areas
324
Stowage well under the luggage compartment floor
Stowing and features
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you drive when the luggage compartment
floor is open, objects could be flung around,
thus striking vehicle occupants. There is a risk
of injury, especially when braking or abruptly
changing directions.
Always close the luggage compartment floor
before a journey.
X
Fold out hook = on the underside of the
luggage compartment floor.
X
Attach hook = to the luggage compartment's upper seal ?.
! The maximum load capacity of the stowage well under the luggage compartment
floor is 25 kg.
There is a stowage area for TIREFIT, the vehicle tool kit, a folding box, etc. underneath the
luggage compartment floor.
Opening/closing the luggage compartment floor
To close: detach hook = from upper
seal ?.
X Fasten hook = to the bracket on the
underside of the luggage compartment
floor.
X Fold the luggage compartment floor down.
X Press the luggage compartment floor down
until it engages.
X
To open: open the tailgate.
Holding ribbing ;, press handle : downwards.
Handle : folds upwards.
X Swing the luggage compartment floor
upwards using handle : until it rests
against the luggage compartment cover.
X
X
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the luggage compartment floor can be locked and
unlocked with the emergency key element.
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When a load is transported on the roof, the
vehicle's centre of gravity rises and the han-
Features
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Ensure that, depending on the vehicle's
equipment, you can raise the panorama
sliding sunroof fully and open the tailgate
fully when the roof carrier is fitted.
You will find information on the maximum roof
load in the "Technical data" section
(Y page 410).
An incorrectly secured roof carrier or roof
load may become detached from the vehicle.
You must therefore ensure that you observe
the roof carrier manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Attaching the roof carrier
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X
Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The cup holder cannot secure a drinks container in place during a journey. If you use a
cup holder during a journey, the drinks container could be flung around and liquid could
be spilt. Vehicle occupants could come into
contact with the liquid and, in particular, be
scalded by hot liquid. You could be distracted
from the traffic situation and lose control of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident and
injury.
Only use the cup holder when the vehicle is
stationary. Only place containers of a suitable
size in the cup holder. Seal the container, in
particular when it contains hot liquid.
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces before
starting a journey.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the luggage compartment.
Z
Stowing and features
dling changes. If you exceed the maximum
roof load, the handling as well as steering and
braking characteristics are severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always observe the maximum roof load and
adapt your driving style.
325
Features
326
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 316).
The stowage compartments in the doors provide space for bottles:
Stowing and features
Rfront:
Rrear:
capacity up to 1.0 l
capacity up to 0.5 l
Cup holders in the front centre console
upper section of the cup holder faces forwards.
X Press cup holder : downwards until it
engages on the right and left-hand sides.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight
on the rear seat armrest when it is folded
down, as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the
rear seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup
holder could be damaged.
Two coin holders = and a card holder ; can
be found in the cup holder.
The cup holder and the rubber mat underneath can be removed for cleaning. Clean
them with clean, lukewarm water only.
X To remove: lift the cup holder up : and
out with a brief tug.
X
To fit: insert cup holder : into lateral
curved sections ; in the stowage compartment. When doing so, insert the cup
holder in such a way that the cant of the
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
To open: press the front of cup holder :
or ;.
Cup holder : or ; extends automatically.
X To close: slide cup holder : or ; back
until it engages.
X
X
Features
327
Sun visors
Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: lift insert = up ;
and out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
i If you remove the ashtray insert, you can
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
Rear-compartment ashtray
Glare from the side
Fold down sun visor :.
Pull sun visor : out of retainer ;.
X Swing sun visor : to the side.
X
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
To open: pull cover = out by its top edge.
To remove: pull insert ; by recess : in
the direction of arrow ? until it audibly
releases.
X Lift insert ; up and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert ; from above
into the holder and press down until it
engages.
X
X
Z
Stowing and features
Overview
Features
328
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Stowing and features
Rthe
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
12 V sockets
General notes
X
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as mobile phone
chargers.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
An emergency cut-off ensures that the onboard voltage does not drop too low. If the onboard voltage is too low, the power to the
sockets is automatically cut. This ensures
that there is sufficient power to start the
engine.
Socket in the front centre console
Vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover: press the lower section of cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X
Features
329
To open: press cover : briefly.
To make an emergency call: press SOS
button ; briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button ;
flashes until the emergency call is concluded.
X Wait for a voice connection to the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre.
X After the emergency call, close cover :.
You will see a message if:
X
X
X
X
Pull cover : out by its top edge.
Lift up the cover of socket ;.
Socket in the luggage compartment
Ra
connection to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre cannot be made
Ra call has not been automatically forwarded to the public emergency call centre
In this case, dial the 112 emergency number on your mobile phone.
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Information on these requirements can be
found in the separate Audio 20 or COMAND
Online operating instructions.
You can find more information on the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system in the
separate Audio 20 or COMAND Online operating instructions.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Stowing and features
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
Stowing and features
330
Features
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating mobile communications
equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios
and mobile phones (RF transmitters)
(Y page 400).
Rthe
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones to
COMAND Online/Audio 20 can be obtained:
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Ron
Using a mobile phone
To connect a mobile phone to the exterior
aerial and charge it, insert it into the mobile
phone bracket.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 318).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed fitting; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
i The mobile phone can also be operated
without being in the bracket. However, the
charging function and aerial function are
not available.
In order to use Bluetooth® (SAP profile) on
your telephone module, you must first insert
the telephone module into the pre-installed
fitting. This connects it to the exterior aerial.
If you wish to charge the mobile phone, then
you must connect it to a USB port.
Further information on the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) can be found in
the Digital Owner's Manual.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
Features
scribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Mobile phone bracket in the stowage
compartment
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press safety catch knobs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
X
X
You can fold the pre-installed bracket up to
improve access to the stowage space
beneath it.
Further information about the stowage compartment (Y page 318).
X To fold the bracket up: press button :.
X To fold the bracket down: press the
bracket down and allow it to engage.
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
Floormats
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as preZ
Stowing and features
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 254).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone is disconnected from
the vehicle. You can then no longer make calls
using the hands-free system.
If a call is active and you remove the key from
the ignition lock, the conversation is transferred over to the mobile phone. It is then
possible to continue the conversation on the
mobile phone.
331
332
333
Useful information ............................ 334
Engine compartment ........................ 334
ASSYST PLUS .................................... 339
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 340
334
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Maintenance and care
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open up when the
vehicle is in motion and block your view. There
is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet when driving. Before
every trip, ensure that the bonnet is locked.
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Rremove jewellery and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
G WARNING
The ignition system and the fuel injection system operate with a high voltage. If you touch
the live components, you could receive an
electric shock. There is a danger of injury.
Never touch components of the ignition system or the fuel injection system when the
ignition is switched on.
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional
pedestrian protection provided by the
active bonnet will then be restored.
The active bonnet is only available in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury
to pedestrians in certain accident situations.
Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge
by approximately 60 mm.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active
Engine compartment
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
X
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on
both sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly in
the area around the hinges, it is not engaged
correctly. Repeat the step.
If the bonnet can then still be raised, drive
directly to a qualified specialist workshop. Do
not drive faster than 100 km/h.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Reach into the gap between the bonnet and
the radiator trim and press bonnet catch
lever ; to the left.
X Raise the bonnet.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection may be limited.
335
Engine compartment
336
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly, wait approximately
30 minutes before carrying out the measurement
Maintenance and care
Rthe
X
X
Pull support strut ? out of bracket A.
Lift up support strut ? and insert it into
yellow retaining clip =.
Closing the bonnet
Raise the bonnet slightly and, at the same
time, remove support strut ? from yellow
retaining clip =.
X Swing support strut ? down and press it
into bracket A until it engages.
X Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Do not press the bonnet
closed. Open the bonnet again and close it
with a little more force.
X
Engine oil
General notes
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Engine compartment
337
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
Pull dipstick : out of the dipstick tube.
Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark =
or below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
X
Topping up engine oil
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with
too much engine oil can result in damage to
the engine or to the catalytic converter.
Have excess engine oil siphoned off.
Z
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
Engine compartment
338
Maintenance and care
damage to the engine or engine cooling
system.
Example: engine oil filler cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine
oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 336).
X
X
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 406).
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
The cooling system is pressurised, particularly when the engine is warm. If you open the
cap, you could be scalded if hot coolant
sprays out. There is a risk of injury.
Let the engine cool down before you open the
cap. Wear gloves and eye protection. Open
the cap slowly to release the pressure.
! The coolant level must only be checked
and corrected when the engine has cooled
down (coolant temperature under 40 †).
Checking the coolant level when the coolant temperature is over 40 † can lead to
Example
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
40 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Slowly turn cap : anti-clockwise to allow
excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
X
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 408).
ASSYST PLUS
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
If the washer fluid level drops below 1 litre, a
message appears in the multifunction display
prompting you to top up the washer fluid
(Y page 299).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 409).
ASSYST PLUS
Service message
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
You can find information on the type of service and service intervals in the Service Booklet.
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 336).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
RService
A in .. days
A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after
the letter A or B indicates any necessary additional maintenance work. If you notify a qualified specialist workshop of this display, you
will receive a statement on the associated
costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
RService
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
On vehicles with the headlamp cleaning system, the recommended minimum washer
fluid level is 3.5 litres.
On vehicles not equipped with the headlamp
cleaning system, the recommended minimum washer fluid level is 1 litre.
Z
Maintenance and care
Topping up the windscreen washer system/headlamp cleaning system
339
Care
340
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on
normal operation of the vehicle. Service work
will need to be performed more often if the
vehicle is operated under arduous conditions
or increased loads, for example:
Maintenance and care
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button to select the
Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
ate stops
the vehicle is primarily used to travel
short distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
In these or similar operating conditions, have,
for example, the air filter, engine oil and oil
filter changed more frequently. The tyres
must be checked more frequently if the vehicle is operated under increased loads. Further information can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Rif
Driving abroad
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service
interval display
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval dis-
play has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rabrasive
Care
Rcleaning
agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! When DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD
function is activated, the vehicle brakes
automatically in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS and the HOLD function in
the following or similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing away
a car wash
! Make sure that the automatic transmis-
sion is in position N when washing your
vehicle in a tow-through car wash. The vehicle could be damaged if the transmission is
in another position.
! Make sure that:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed/
airflow control is turned to position 0).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
Z
Maintenance and care
Rsolvents
341
Care
342
Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
X
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
Maintenance and care
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
! Edition 1 special model: parts of your
vehicle are covered with a decorative foil.
Maintain a distance of at least 70 cm
between the foil-wrapped parts of the vehi-
cle and the nozzle of the high pressure
cleaner.
Information about the correct distance is
available from the equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resins,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
Care
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
Rvigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials
Rfrequent use of car washes
Rwashing the vehicle in direct sunlight
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
The vehicle should preferably be washed by
hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of water.
Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of approved Mercedes-Benz
care products.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Z
Maintenance and care
! The following may cause the paint to
343
Care
344
Cleaning the wiper blades
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
Cleaning the mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
X
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pres-
sure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Care
345
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Open the camera cover for cleaning using
COMAND Online or Audio 20 (see separate
operating instructions).
X To clean the reversing camera: use clean
water and a soft cloth to clean camera
lens :.
X
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing the vehicle.
X Clean the exhaust pipe with a care product
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Please note the care instructions in the
trailer coupling manufacturer's operating
instructions.
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe and tail pipe trim can
become very hot. If you come into contact
with these parts of the vehicle, you could burn
yourself. There is a risk of injury.
Always be particularly careful around the
exhaust tail pipe and the tail pipe trim. Allow
these components to cool down before touching them.
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents, such as sanitary
cleanser or wheel cleaner.
! Mercedes-AMG vehicles with black
exhaust pipes: the black-chrome tailpipe
finishers should not be polished with a
chrome polish. They will otherwise lose
their black sheen. For optimal care, the finishers should be rubbed with a lightly oiled
cloth after every car wash. Commercially
available engine and care oils are suitable
for this.
Remove rust, e.g. with a wire brush.
Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or a
brush.
X After cleaning, lightly oil or grease ball coupling :.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
X
i You can also have the maintenance work
on the ball coupling and the trailer tow hitch
Z
Maintenance and care
For heavier soiling, you can apply a fine
paintwork polish with a microfibre cloth.
Remove the excess polish residue after polishing.
Care
346
carried out by a qualified specialist workshop.
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Maintenance and care
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use a microfibre cloth to clean
covers made out of real leather, artificial
leather or DINAMICA. If used frequently,
this can damage the cover.
Note that regular care is essential to make
sure that the appearance and comfort of the
covers are retained over time.
Care
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully, and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
RClean DINAMICA covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
Z
Maintenance and care
Genuine leather seat covers
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
347
348
349
Useful information ............................ 350
Where will I find...? ........................... 350
Flat tyre ............................................. 352
Battery (vehicle) ................................ 356
Jump-starting .................................... 360
Towing away and tow-starting ........ 362
Breakdown assistance
Electrical fuses ................................. 367
Where will I find...?
350
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Breakdown assistance
ist workshops: (Y page 25).
Where will I find...?
X
X
Warning triangle
Removing/replacing the warning triangle
To remove: open the tailgate.
X Lift the luggage compartment floor
upwards (Y page 324).
X To release warning triangle :, push back
the retainers on the bracket.
X Remove warning triangle : from the
bracket.
X To replace: place warning triangle : back
into the bracket and push down to secure.
X Fold down the luggage compartment floor.
X Close the tailgate.
X
Fold feet = out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
press stud :.
First-aid kit
X
X
Open the tailgate.
Remove first-aid kit :.
Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit at
least once a year. Replace the contents if
necessary, and replace any missing items.
Where will I find...?
351
Necessary tyre-changing tools can include,
for example:
Fire extinguisher
RJack
RWheel
chock
wrench
RCentring pin
RWheel
The fire extinguisher is located underneath
the front of the driver's seat.
X Pull tab : upwards.
X Remove fire extinguisher ;.
Have the fire extinguisher refilled after each
use and checked every one or two years. It
may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the TIREFIT kit is
located in the stowage well under the luggage
compartment floor.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit: the tyrechange tool kit is in the stowage well under
the luggage compartment floor.
For vehicles with an emergency spare wheel,
see "Removing the emergency spare wheel"
(Y page 397).
i Apart from some country-specific var-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tyre changing tools
are required and approved to perform a
wheel change on your vehicle, consult a
qualified specialist workshop.
: Tyre inflation compressor
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
= Towing eye
Open the tailgate.
Lift the luggage compartment floor
upwards (Y page 324).
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 353).
X
X
i Towing eye ; is located under tyre inflation compressor :.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit
Open the tailgate.
Lift the luggage compartment floor
upwards (Y page 324).
X Remove the tyre-change tool kit.
X
X
The tyre-change tool kit contains:
RJack
RWheel
wrench
pair of gloves
RFolding wheel chock
ROne
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
352
Flat tyre
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Breakdown assistance
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
acteristics) (Y page 352)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 351)
Ran emergency spare wheel (certain countries only) (Y page 396)
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Information on changing and fitting a wheel
(Y page 379).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 192).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's
door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/
Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 165).
X Make sure that the passengers are not
endangered as they do so. Make sure that
no one is near the danger area while a
wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not
directly assisting in the wheel change
should, for example, stand behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle at a suitable distance (Y page 350). Observe legal requirements.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres. The affected
tyre must not show any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the
tyre wall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
If a pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
Robserve the instructions in the display mes-
sages (Y page 292)
the tyre for damage
Rif driving on, observe the following notes
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is
partially laden and approximately 30 km
when the vehicle is fully laden.
Rcheck
Flat tyre
Rvehicle
holes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Rroad
Ryou
speed
condition
Routside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
is counted from the moment the tyre pressure
loss warning appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
When replacing one or all tyres, observe the
following specifications for your vehicle's
tyres:
Rsize
Rtype
and
"MOExtended" mark.
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tyre, a standard tyre
may be used as a temporary measure. Make
sure that you use the proper size and type
(summer or winter tyre).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, pot-
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
Z
Breakdown assistance
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
353
Flat tyre
354
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
Breakdown assistance
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
underneath the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 351).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker to the
instrument cluster within the driver's field
of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than ten minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Comply with the manufacturer’s safety
instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
Using the TIREFIT kit
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage well
Remove filler hose B and connector =
from the bottom section of tyre inflation
compressor housing ;.
X Slide the yellow filler hose connector into
the mounting on yellow cap A of tyre sealant bottle : until the connector engages.
X With the sealing rings in front, slide yellow
cap A of tyre sealant bottle : into the
holder of tyre inflation compressor ;.
Yellow cap A and both hooks must
engage.
X
X
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X
X
Insert plug = into a 12 V socket in your
vehicle.
Flat tyre
If a pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi) has
been attained after five minutes, see "Tyre
pressure reached" (Y page 355).
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi)
has not been attained after five minutes, see
"Tyre pressure not reached" (Y page 355).
If tyre sealant leaks out, make sure you clean
the affected area as quickly as possible. It is
preferable to use clear water.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
The maximum permissible speed for a tyre
sealed with tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The
upper part of the TIREFIT sticker must be
affixed to the instrument cluster where it will
be easily seen by the driver.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
Tyre pressure not reached
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi)
has not been attained after ten minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
Please note that tyre sealant may leak out
when unscrewing the filler hose.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of ten minutes, the tyre
pressure must be at least 200 kPa (2.0 bar/
29 psi).
X
X
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi)
has been attained after ten minutes:
X
X
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Observe the notes on sockets
(Y page 328).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Press on and off switch ? on the tyre inflation compressor to ON.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure may briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X Let the tyre inflation compressor run for a
maximum of ten minutes. The tyre should
then have attained a pressure of at least
200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi).
355
Battery (vehicle)
356
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button : next to pressure gauge ;.
X When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of
the sealed tyre.
X
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the tyre
pressure table on the fuel filler flap for values.
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
X
To remove the tyre sealant bottle from the
tyre inflation compressor, press together
the locking tabs on the yellow cap.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X
Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle and the filler
hose replaced as soon as possible at a
qualified specialist workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can lead, for example, to a short circuit and
thus damage the vehicle electronics. This can
lead to function restrictions applying to
safety-relevant systems, e.g the lighting system, the ABS (anti-lock braking system) or the
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program). The operating safety of your vehicle may be restricted.
You could lose control of the vehicle, for
example:
Rwhen
braking
Rin the event of abrupt steering manoeuvres
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or a similar incident, contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. Always
have work on the battery carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Further information about ABS (Y page 73)
and ESP® (Y page 76).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic charge is created, for example:
Rby
wearing synthetic fibre clothing
friction between clothing and the seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
Rby
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a col-
Z
357
Breakdown assistance
Battery (vehicle)
358
Battery (vehicle)
lection point for used batteries.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
Breakdown assistance
! You should have all work involving the
battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. In the exceptional case that it is
necessary for you to disconnect the battery
yourself, make sure that:
Ryou switch off the engine and remove the
key. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO,
ensure that the ignition is switched off.
Check that all the indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
electronic components, such as the
alternator, may be damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged.
Rin vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be fitted securely during operation.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when handling the
battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing,
in particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes
off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event of
an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
When you park the vehicle, remove the key if
you do not require any electrical consumers.
The vehicle will then use very little energy,
thus conserving battery power.
Battery (vehicle)
Rset
the clock via Audio 20 or COMAND
Online (see separate operating instructions)
Rreset the function for folding the exterior
mirrors in/out automatically, by folding the
mirrors out once (Y page 120).
Charging the battery
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not
lean over the battery. Keep the batteries out
of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off
battery acid thoroughly with plenty of clean
water and seek medical attention at once.
X
X
Open the bonnet.
Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure (Y page 360).
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up
at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case
you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor
charge the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced.
The starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. A battery
charger unit specially adapted for MercedesBenz vehicles and tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz is available as an accessory.
This device permits charging of the battery in
position. Contact a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for information and availability. Read
the battery charger's operating instructions
before charging the battery.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 360).
Z
Breakdown assistance
If the power supply has been interrupted, e.g.
if the battery was discharged, you will have to:
359
360
Jump-starting
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not breathe in any battery gases. Do not lean over
the battery. Keep the batteries out of the reach of children. Immediately rinse off battery acid
thoroughly with plenty of clean water and seek medical attention at once.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise,
the non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge
the battery. Let the battery thaw first. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may
be reduced. The starting characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures.
Have the thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Jump-starting
361
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may only be performed using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that are not damaged and have a sufficient cross-section and insulated
terminal clamps.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
RThe
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts
while the jump leads are connected to the battery.
jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is
running, such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Manual transmission: depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to neutral.
X Automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it.
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
RThe
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
X
X
Press together cover : of positive clamp ; and slide it back.
Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead, beginning with your own battery.
Z
Breakdown assistance
RThe
Towing away and tow-starting
362
Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the
jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive clamp ; and positive terminal =. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle
first.
X Close cover : of positive clamp ; after removing the jump leads.
X Close the bonnet.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Breakdown assistance
X
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Towing away and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Safety relevant functions are restricted or no
longer available if:
Rthe
engine is not running
brake system or power steering is malfunctioning
Rthere is a malfunction in the voltage supply
or the vehicle's electrical system
When your vehicle is towed away or towed
started, you may require considerably more
effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such cases use a rigid towing bar. Before
being towed away or tow started, make sure
the steering moves freely.
Rthe
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
G WARNING
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle
and its weight is greater than the permissible
gross weight of your vehicle, the:
Rtowing
eye may be torn off
combination may swerve or
even overturn
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Rcar/trailer
Details on the permissible gross vehicle
weight of your vehicle can be found on the
vehicle identification plate (Y page 402).
! When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS, DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To avoid
damage to the vehicle, deactivate these
systems in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing away
a car wash
Towing away and tow-starting
is released. If the electric parking brake is
faulty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to
the towing eyes or, if available, to the trailer
tow hitch. You could otherwise damage the
vehicle.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
RSecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
RMake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope
in the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This will make other road
users aware that a vehicle is being
towed.
ROnly secure the tow cable to the towing
eyes or, if available, to the trailer tow
hitch.
RObserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance a distance so that the tow rope
does not sag.
RDo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery
purposes as this could damage the vehicle.
If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power
is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the front
axle or the entire vehicle must be raised
and transported.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use
the key instead of the Start/Stop button.
The automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the
driver's or front-passenger door which
could damage the transmission.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing and tow-starting.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
If the vehicle can no longer be driven because
of an accident or breakdown, you have the
following options:
Rtransporting
the vehicle
As a rule, you should have the vehicle transported.
Rtowing the vehicle with a tow rope or tow
bar
Only tow the vehicle in exceptional cases.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock
Rcannot release the electric parking brake
Rcannot shift the transmission to position N
on vehicles with automatic transmission
The function of the electric parking brake and
the parking lock is dependent on the on-board
voltage.
If the on-board voltage is low or if there is a
system malfunction:
Rit may not be possible to apply the released
parking brake or
may not be possible to shift the transmission to position P
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. the
radio.
Deactivate the automatic locking feature
before towing the vehicle (Y page 260). You
could otherwise be locked out when pushing
or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection before towing away the vehicle (Y page 82).
Rit
Z
Breakdown assistance
! Make sure that the electric parking brake
363
Towing away and tow-starting
364
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
Place the towing eye in the stowage well
under the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 351).
X Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: replace the tyre
inflation compressor.
X
Breakdown assistance
Towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised
When towing your vehicle with the front axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 362).
Only vehicles without 4MATIC can be
towed with the front axle raised.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
rear and at the front, under covers :.
X Remove the towing eye from the stowage
space.
The towing eye is located with the vehicle
tool kit under the luggage compartment
floor (Y page 351).
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the towing eye
is located under the tyre inflation compressor.
X Press the mark on cover : inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover : from the opening.
X Screw in the towing eye clockwise to the
stop.
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch only have a
bracket at the front for the screw-in towing
eye. If you intend to use the vehicle for towing, fold out the ball coupling (Y page 240)
and secure the towbar to it.
Removing the towing eye
X
X
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Attach cover : to the bumper and press
until it engages.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may either be towed
away with both axles on the ground or be loaded up and transported.
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the
KEYLESS-GO start function: you must
use the key instead of the Start/Stop button (Y page 167).
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
or
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
neutral.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X
Towing away and tow-starting
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 362).
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO or the
KEYLESS-GO start function: you must
use the key instead of the Start/Stop button (Y page 167).
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
automatic transmission automatically shifts
to position P when you open the driver's or
front-passenger door or when you remove the
key from the ignition lock. In order to ensure
that the automatic transmission stays in position N when towing away the vehicle, you
must observe the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
Vehicles with manual or automatic transmission:
Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 129).
X
i In order to signal a change of direction
when towing the vehicle with the hazard
warning lamps switched on, use the combination switch as usual. In this case, only
the turn signals for the desired direction
flash. When you reset the combination
switch, the hazard warning lamps start
flashing again.
Transporting the vehicle
4MATIC vehicles/vehicles with automatic transmission
X
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
X
! When the vehicle is loaded for transport,
the front and rear axles must be stationary
and on the same transportation vehicle.
Positioning over the connection point of the
transport vehicle is not permitted. The drive
train may otherwise be damaged.
All vehicles
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Deactivate tow-away protection
(Y page 82).
X Deactivate automatic locking (Y page 260).
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 129).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and leave the key in the ignition lock.
X
365
Towing away and tow-starting
366
Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
neutral.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 165).
X Shift the transmission to position N.
X
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
Breakdown assistance
X
The towing eyes or trailer tow hitch can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may only be either
towed away with both axles on the ground or
be loaded up and transported.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or
damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported on a transporter or trailer.
In the event of damage to the electrical
system:
If the battery is defective, the automatic
transmission will be locked in position P. To
shift the automatic transmission to position
N, you must provide power to the vehicle's
electrical system in the same way as when
jump-starting (Y page 360).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter
or trailer.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
i You can find information on "Jump-starting" under (Y page 360).
Before tow-starting, the following conditions
must be fulfilled:
Rthe
battery is connected
engine has cooled down
Rthe exhaust system has cooled down
When tow-starting, it is important that you
observe the safety notes (Y page 362) and the
legal requirements in each respective country.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 129).
X Fit the towing eye (Y page 364).
X Secure the rigid towing bar or the towing
rope.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 165).
X Depress the clutch pedal fully, engage second gear and continue to keep the clutch
pedal fully depressed.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly; do not
depress the accelerator pedal while doing
so.
X When the engine has been started, immediately depress the clutch pedal fully and
shift to neutral.
X Pull over at a suitable place and stop the
vehicle safely, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
Rthe
Electrical fuses
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's
door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the front-passenger footwell
The fuse allocation chart is on the fuse box in
the front-passenger footwell (Y page 368).
Fuse box in the engine compartment
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
The fuses in your vehicle disconnect faulty
circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on
the circuit and their functions will fail.
Before replacing a fuse
Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 192).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
Use the electric parking brake to secure the
vehicle and prevent it from rolling away.
X Remove the rigid towing bar or towing rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 364).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
X
367
Electrical fuses
368
Open the bonnet.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X To open: open clamps ;.
X Fold cover : up in the direction of the
arrow and remove it.
X
X
To open: open the front-passenger door.
Remove the floormat.
X Fold out perforated floor covering : in the
direction of the arrow.
X
Breakdown assistance
X
To close: check whether the seal is lying
correctly in cover :.
X Insert cover : at the back into openings
= on the fuse box.
X Fold down cover :.
X Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and
close.
X Close the bonnet.
X
To release cover =, press retaining
clamp ;.
X Fold out cover = in the direction of the
arrow to the catch.
X Remove cover = forwards.
Fuse allocation chart ? is located on the
lower right-hand side of cover =.
X To close: insert cover = on the left-hand
side of the fuse box into the retainer.
Cover = engages in the retainers.
X Fold down cover = until clamps ; lock
audibly.
X Fold back perforated floor covering :.
X Fit the floormats.
X
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
369
Useful information ............................ 370
Important safety notes ..................... 370
Operation ........................................... 370
Winter operation ............................... 372
Tyre pressure .................................... 374
Changing a wheel .............................. 379
Wheel and tyre combinations .......... 384
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel ................... 396
370
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being
used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rtype
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on the sizes and types of wheels
and tyres for your vehicle can be found under
"Wheel/tyre combinations" (Y page 384).
Information on tyre pressures can be found:
Rfactory
Rin
the tyre pressure table in the fuel filler
flap (Y page 189)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 374)
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of spacers or
brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating permit for the
vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressure when the vehicle is
heavily laden and adjust prior to a trip.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics,
e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that
the wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that a tyre is defective, reduce your
speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon
as possible to check the wheels and tyres for
damage. Hidden tyre damage could also be
Operation
causing the unusual handling characteristics.
If you find no signs of damage, have the tyres
and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure not to
squash the tyre sidewalls. If this cannot be
avoided, drive slowly over obstacles, e.g.
kerbs, and only at an obtuse angle. You could
otherwise damage the wheel rims and tyres.
371
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 396).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rmileage
Rtyre
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
Check wheels and tyres for damage at least
once a month. Check wheels and tyres after
driving off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tyre pressure. Pay
particular attention to damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears
in the tyres
on the tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 371). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 374).
Rbulges
G WARNING
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These
Z
Wheels and tyres
Notes on the tyre tread
Wheels and tyres
372
Winter operation
requirements can stipulate a specific tyre
type for your vehicle. Furthermore, the use of
certain tyre types in certain regions and areas
of operation can be highly beneficial. You can
find further information regarding tyres at
specialist tyre retailers, at qualified specialist
workshops or at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
ROnly fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe here the "MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 352).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 396).
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or with an activated tyre pressure monitor and on wheels specifically tested by Mercedes-Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 352).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 379).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
Winter operation
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 374).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 376).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 378).
X
X
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 396).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If snow chains are fitted to the rear wheels,
they may scrape against the vehicle body or
chassis components. This could cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres. There is a risk
of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
fit snow chains on the rear wheels
fit snow chains in pairs to the front
wheels.
Ralways
! Vehicles with steel wheels: if you fit
snow chains on steel wheels, you may damage the hub caps. Remove the hub caps
from the relevant wheels before fitting the
snow chains.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality. For more information, please contact a qualified specialist
workshop.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 384).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the
snow chains as soon as possible when you
come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Rwhen snow chains are fitted, never use
Active Parking Assist (Y page 220).
You may wish to deactivate ESP® (Y page 77)
when pulling away with snow chains fitted.
This way you can allow the wheels to spin in a
controlled manner, achieving increased driving force (cutting action).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 396).
Z
Wheels and tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tyres will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter. These tyres have
been developed specifically for driving in
snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 204).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
373
374
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Wheels and tyres
Rthe
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
The recommended tyre pressures for various
operating conditions can be found in the tyre
pressure table on the fuel filler flap
(Y page 189).
Operation with an emergency spare
wheel: information on operation with an
emergency spare wheel can be found in the
general notes in the "Emergency spare wheel"
section (Y page 396).
Operation with a trailer: the applicable
value for the rear axle is the maximum tyre
pressure value stated in the table inside the
fuel filler flap.
Additionally, the tyre pressure table may also
state tyre pressures for different load conditions. These are defined in the table as different numbers of passengers and amounts
of luggage. The actual number of seats may
vary; for more information, please refer to the
vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure table apply
for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
Tyre pressure
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
vehicle speed and the load on the tyres, the
tyre temperature and thus the tyre pressure
changes by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/
1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this into account
when checking the pressure of warm tyres.
Only correct the tyre pressure if it is too low
for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
The tyre pressure values given for low loads
are minimum values which offer you good ride
comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
Rcause
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a
loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss
warning by the Run Flat Indicator
active Restart with OK message which
appears in the multifunction display in the
Serv.menu. Information on the message disServ.
play can be found in the "Restarting the tyre
pressure loss warning system" section
(Y page 376).
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 374).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressures. An even loss of pressure on several tyres at the same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer.
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Z
Wheels and tyres
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
375
Tyre pressure
376
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
If you wish to cancel the restart:
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
or
Wheels and tyres
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
for the respective operating conditions.
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the tyre pressure table on the fuel
filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect
tyre pressure is set, these incorrect values
will be monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 374).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 165).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
Press the % button.
If the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre
is shown in the Serv. menu of the multifunction display, see illustration (example).
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
For further information on displaying this
message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically" section (Y page 377).
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 374). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
Tyre pressure
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tyre pressure on one or more tyres is significantly too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
In addition to the warning lamp, a message
appears in the multifunction display. Observe
the information on display messages
(Y page 292).
It may take up to ten minutes for a malfunction of the tyre pressure monitor to be indicated. A malfunction will be indicated by the
tyre pressure warning lamp flashing for
approximately one minute and then remaining lit. When the fault has been rectified, the
tyre pressure warning lamp goes out after you
have driven for a few minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those meas-
ured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 165).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle was parked for longer than
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message is shown.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically detects new wheels or
new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of
the tyre pressure values to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tyre pressure
monitor active message is shown instead
of the tyre pressure display. The tyre pressures are already being monitored.
If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, for a
few minutes the system may continue to
show the tyre pressure of the wheel that has
been removed. If this occurs, note that the
value displayed for the position where the
spare wheel is fitted is not the same as the
current tyre pressure of the emergency spare
wheel.
Z
Wheels and tyres
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting to the cold tyre pressure
(Y page 378). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 374).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending
on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up,
a tyre pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
377
378
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display.
The yellow tyre pressure warning lamp then
lights up.
Wheels and tyres
RIf
the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in at least one tyre is
too low. The tyre pressure must be corrected when the opportunity arises.
RIf the Tyre pressure Check tyre(s)
message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in one or more tyres
has dropped significantly. The tyres must
be checked.
RIf the Tyre pressure Caution Tyre
malfunction message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in one
or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
tyres must be checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 292).
If the wheel positions on the vehicle are interchanged, the tyre pressures may be displayed
for the wrong positions for a short time. After
a few minutes of driving, this is rectified and
the tyre pressures are displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
you can also set reference values manually as
described here. The tyre pressure monitor
then monitors the new tyre pressure values.
Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 374).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 165).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv.
Serv.menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for each tyre or the
Tyre pressures will be displayed
after a few minutes of driving message.
X Press the : button.
The multifunction display shows the Use
current pressures as new reference
values message.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
DA- 103365
TA-2012/719
TA-2012/1540
TA-2011/1370
Country
Radio type approval number
Argentina
MW2433A
H-12337
GG4
H-12338
South
Africa
Brazil
2770-12-8001
Model: MW2433A
0381-13-8001
Model: GG4
Changing a wheel
Abu
Dhabi
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
ER0092100/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0099792/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer NO: DA0047074/10
Jordan
Model: Gen Alpha Wal 2 TPMS
transmitter
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/114
Model: Gen Gamma Gen
4 433.92 Mhz.
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/190
Model: Corax 3 MRXMC34MA4
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2011/158
Type Number: LPD
Morocco
MR7319 ANRT 2012/
11/07/2012
MR7672 ANRT 2012/
23/11/2012
MR6706 ANRT 2011
Moldova
1024
Philippines
No: ESD-1206394C
No: ESD-1306871C
Serbia
И 011 12
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 352). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of
a flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown
assistance" (Y page 352).
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel:
in the event of a flat tyre, the emergency
spare wheel is fitted according to the description under "Fitting a wheel" (Y page 380).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
379
Changing a wheel
Wheels and tyres
380
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of
differing dimensions can render the general
operating permit invalid.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Changing a wheel" section (Y page 379).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure the direction of
rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. These advantages can only be
gained if the tyres are fitted corresponding to
the direction of rotation.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Storing wheels
Store wheels in a cool, dry and preferably
dark place if they are not being used. Protect
the tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's
door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO start-function or KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/
Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 165).
X If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
X Safeguard the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 192).
X
i Apart from some country-specific var-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tools are required to
perform a wheel change on your vehicle,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary tyre-changing tools may
include, for example:
RJack
RWheel
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually.
X
RWheel
chock
wrench
Changing a wheel
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
381
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
Observe the following when raising the
vehicle:
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 351).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to safeguard the vehicle
from rolling away, for example when changing
a wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
X
Place chocks or other suitable items under
the front and rear of the wheel that is diagonally opposite the wheel you wish to
change.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not permissible to
use it to perform maintenance work under
the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, safeguard it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and positioning wheel chocks. Do not
release the parking brake while the vehicle
is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, flat load-bearing underlay must be
used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip
underlay must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Rto
Changing a wheel
382
Rdo
not open or close a door or the tailgate
while the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Vehicles with steel wheels: the hub cap
covers the wheel bolts. Before you can
unscrew the wheel bolts, you must remove
the hub cap.
Wheels and tyres
Jacking points
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: to protect the vehicle
body, the vehicle has covers fitted next to the
jacking points on the outer sills.
X
Using both hands, carefully reach into two
wheel trim openings and remove the wheel
trim.
Covers, front (example: vehicles with AMG equipment)
X
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: fold cover ;
upwards.
Changing a wheel
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Observe the instructions and safety notes on
"Changing a wheel" (Y page 379).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
Wheels and tyres
Take ratchet ring spanner A out of the
vehicle tool kit and place it on the hexagon
nut of jack ? so that the letters AUF are
visible.
X Position jack ? at jacking point =.
X
Turn ratchet ring spanner A until jack ?
sits completely on jacking point = and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn ratchet ring spanner A until the tyre
is raised a maximum of 3 cm from the
ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
X
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
383
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Place the new wheel on the wheel hub and
push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
384
Place the ratchet ring spanner onto the
hexagon nut of the jack so that the letters
AB are visible.
X Turn the ratchet ring spanner until the vehicle is once again standing firmly on the
ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
Wheels and tyres
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the vehicle again.
X Mercedes-AMG vehicles and vehicles
with AMG equipment: insert the cover
into the outer sill.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 374).
X
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning
system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot
function reliably. Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure
monitor when the defective wheel has been
replaced with a new wheel.
Vehicles with a tyre pressure monitor: all
fitted wheels must be equipped with functioning sensors.
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not fit
used tyres if you have no information about
their previous usage.
Wheel and tyre combinations
385
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the tyre pressure table on the fuel
filler flap. Further information on tyre pressure (Y page 374). Check tyre pressures regularly and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
Wheels and tyres
RFA:
Rwith
tyres of the same size across an axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 352).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
fitted at the factory in all countries.
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
386
Tyres
CLA 180
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
6
7
Wheel and tyre combinations
387
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 180 d
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
Wheels and tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
6 Available as MOExtended tyres.
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
7
8
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
388
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 200
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
6
7
Wheel and tyre combinations
389
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 200 d
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
6
7
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
390
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
6
7
Wheel and tyre combinations
391
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 220 d
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V6, 10
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
10 Not in conjunction with AMG Line (Code 950).
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
6
7
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
392
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6, 10
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
BA: 205/55 R16 91
Wheels
V6, 10
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
Available as MOExtended tyres.
in conjunction with AMG Line (Code 950).
7 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
6
10 Not
Wheel and tyre combinations
393
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si6, 10
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
Wheels and tyres
CLA 250
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
BA: 225/45 R17 91
Wheels
V7
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y XL7, 8, 9
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
BA: 235/40 R18 95 Y XL11
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Available as MOExtended tyres.
in conjunction with AMG Line (Code 950).
7 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
9 Only in conjunction with tyre pressure monitor (code 475).
11 Only in conjunction with AMG Sport package (Code P84).
6
10 Not
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
394
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 235/40 R18 95 H XL M+Si7, 11
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
CLA 250 4MATIC
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W6, 7
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL6, 7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 235/40 R18 95 Y XL11
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i6
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
8 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
11 Only in conjunction with AMG Sport package (Code P84).
6
7
Wheel and tyre combinations
395
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 235/40 R18 95 H XL M+Si7, 11
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
BA: 235/40 ZR18 95 Y
Wheels
XL7
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 235/35 ZR19 91 Y XL7, 8
BA: 8.0 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si7, 8
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
BA: 235/40 R18 95 H XL M+Si7
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Mercedes-AMG CLA 45 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 235/40 ZR18 95 Y XL7
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
11 Only in conjunction with AMG Sport package (Code P84).
7
8
Z
Emergency spare wheel
396
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 235/35 ZR19 91 Y XL7, 8
BA: 8.0 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 215/45 R18 93 V XL M+S i
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 42.5
BA: 235/40 R18 95 V XL M+S i7
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
7
8
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
General notes
Apart from some country-specific variants,
vehicles are not equipped with an emergency
spare wheel. Emergency spare wheels are
specific to the vehicle. For more information
on which emergency spare wheels are
approved for your vehicle, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
You should regularly check the pressure of
the emergency spare wheel, particularly prior
to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 374). The value on the wheel is
valid. In addition, the emergency spare wheel
tyre pressure can be found under "Technical
data" (Y page 398).
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
Emergency spare wheel
397
If you are driving with the emergency spare
wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss warning
system or the tyre pressure monitor cannot
function reliably. Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure
monitor when the defective wheel has been
replaced with a new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: after
fitting an emergency spare wheel, the system
may still display the tyre pressure of the
removed wheel for a few minutes. The value
displayed for the position where the emergency spare wheel is fitted is not the same as
the current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Wheels and tyres
Removing the emergency spare wheel
Example: vehicles with the "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel is
secured in emergency spare wheel bag : in
the luggage compartment.
X Open the tailgate.
X Release securing straps ; on emergency
spare wheel bag :.
X Remove emergency spare wheel bag :
with the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel.
X Open emergency spare wheel bag : and
remove the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Changing a wheel" section (Y page 380).
Z
398
Emergency spare wheel
Technical data
All models (except Mercedes‑AMG vehicles)
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel12
Tyres
Wheels
T 125/80 R17 99 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 17 H2 ET 19.5
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel12
Wheels
T 125/70 R18 99 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 18 H2 ET 20
Wheels and tyres
Tyres
12 Use
of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
399
Useful information ............................ 400
Information on technical data ......... 400
Vehicle electronics ........................... 400
Identification plates ......................... 402
Service products and capacities ..... 402
Vehicle data ....................................... 410
Technical data
Trailer tow hitch ................................ 411
400
Vehicle electronics
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 25).
Information on technical data
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
tional safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you operate RF transmitters incorrectly in
the vehicle, the electromagnetic radiation
could interfere with the vehicle electronics,
e.g.:
Rif the RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
exterior aerial has been fitted incorrectly or is not a low-reflection type
This could jeopardise the operating safety of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating RF transmitters in the vehicle, always
connect them to the low-reflection exterior
aerial.
Rthe
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors, actuating components and connector leads, at a qualified
specialist workshop. Vehicle components
may otherwise wear more quickly and the
vehicle's operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the opera-
the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
the maximum permissible output in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Robserve
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile
phones (Y page 329).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
Vehicle electronics
401
Approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing
i On vehicles with panorama sliding sun-
roof, fitting an aerial to the front or rear roof
area is not permitted.
On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the
vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters. Comply with the legal
requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 88 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
Mobile communications
(2G/3G/4G)
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
RRF transmitters with transmitter frequencies in the 380 - 410 MHz waveband and a
maximum transmission output of up to 2 W
(trunked radio/Tetra)
RMobile telephones (2G/3G/4G)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
RTrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
R2G/3G/4G
R70
Z
Technical data
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Service products and capacities
402
from the data shown here. You can find the
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
Technical data
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
VIN ; can be seen.
X
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 402).
Only for certain countries: the VIN can also be
found at the lower edge of the windscreen.
Example: vehicles with a trailer tow hitch
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
Engine number
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
countries)
? VIN
A Maximum permissible gross vehicle
Service products and capacities
B
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
C
D
E
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible gross weight of
vehicle/trailer combination (kg) (only for
specific countries)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is example data. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate
Important safety notes
Service products and capacities
Service products include the following:
RFuels
RLubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
RCoolant
RBrake
fluid
RWindscreen
washer fluid
control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. Only use products recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Damage which is caused
by the use of products which have not been
recommended is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz warranty or goodwill gestures. They are listed in this Mercedes-Benz
Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
RClimate
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB-Approval (e.g. MB-Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Other identifications, for example:
R0
W-30
W-30
R5 W-40
R5
i Further information can be obtained from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on
the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Tank capacity
Model
Total capacity
CLA 200 d 4MATIC
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
56.0 l
All other models
50.0 l
Z
Technical data
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
403
404
Service products and capacities
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Approx. 8.0 l
All other models
Approx. 6.0 l
Petrol
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel
system. Even small amounts of the wrong
fuel can result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
Technical data
! Only refuel using unleaded petrol with at
least 95 RON that conforms to the European standard EN 228 or E DIN 51626-1 or
an equivalent specification.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or
E DIN 51626–1 can lead to increased wear
as well as damage to the engine and
exhaust system.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operat-
ing the vehicle with other fuels can lead to
engine failure.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
RE100 (100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85
(petrol with 85% methanol)
(100% methanol)
RPetrol with additives containing metal
RDiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle.
RM100
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
CLA 200, CLA 250, CLA 250 4MATIC: as a
temporary measure, if the recommended fuel
is not available, you may also use regular
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
93 RON.
All other models: as a temporary measure, if
the recommended fuel is not available, you
may also use regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON. This may reduce
engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle and
sudden acceleration. Never refuel using fuel
with a lower RON.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 189).
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol
with at least 98 RON, that conforms to the
European standard EN 228 or E DIN
51626-1 or an equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
Fuel of this specification may contain up to
10% ethanol. Your vehicle is suitable for use
with E10 fuel. You may refuel your vehicle
using E10 fuel.
! As a temporary measure, if the recom-
mended fuel is not available, you may also
Service products and capacities
! As a temporary measure, if the recom-
mended fuel is not available, you may also
use unleaded petrol in emergencies with an
octane rating of 91 RON.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel
consumption, and the engine power output
is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
If no fuel other than petrol with 91 RON or a
lower grade is available, you should have
the vehicle adapted to run on this fuel at a
qualified specialist workshop.
CLA 250 (only for certain countries).
! Only refuel using unleaded, sulphur-free
unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Additives
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do
not mix fuel additives with fuel. This does
not include additives for the removal and
prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must
only be mixed with additives recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for use in the product description.
More information about recommended
additives can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
fuel brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up in the injection system as a result. In
this case, in consultation with a MercedesBenz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Always observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Diesel
Fuel grade
G WARNING
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does
not conform to EN 590 can lead to
increased wear as well as damage to the
engine and exhaust system.
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and
do not use any special additives. Otherwise, engine damage may occur.
Rheating
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
Z
Technical data
use unleaded petrol with an octane rating
of 95 RON. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption.
As much as possible, avoid driving at full
throttle.
405
406
Service products and capacities
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuel with
a high sulphur content is available, you will
need to carry out your vehicle's oil change
at shorter intervals. More information
about the interval for oil change can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
Technical data
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 189).
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low
outside temperatures, it is possible that the
flow characteristics of the diesel fuel could be
insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from
warmer areas may not be suitable for operation in colder climatic conditions.
i Further information on country-specific
fuel properties and fuel types with low-temperature resistance can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient
use of the fuel by the engine
style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or
traffic flow
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
Rdriving
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the
following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
Rin urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
Rwhen towing a trailer
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emissions
values of your vehicle in the COC documents (EU Certificate of Conformity).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
The consumption figures were, in each
case, based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the EURO 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
Engine oil
General notes
When handling engine oil, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 402).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
Service products and capacities
Petrol engines
All models
Diesel engines with a
diesel particle filter
MB-Freigabe
or MBApproval
229.5
MB-Freigabe
or MBApproval
CLA 180 d
226.51,
229.31,
229.51, 229.52
All other models
228.51,
229.31,
229.51, 229.52
Diesel engines without
a diesel particle filter
All models
MB-Freigabe
or MBApproval
228.3, 228.5,
228.51, 229.3,
229.31, 229.5,
229.51, 229.52
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for Mercedes-AMG vehicles.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
RPetrol
engines: MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
RDiesel engines: MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 229.1, 229.3, 229.5 or
ACEA C3
This must only be added once and the
amount must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Petrol engines
Replacement
amount
CLA 180
CLA 200
5.8 l
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
5.6 l
Mercedes-AMG
vehicles
5.5 l
All other models
5.6 l
Diesel engines
Replacement
amount
CLA 180 d
4.5 l
All other models
6.5 l
Z
Technical data
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz approval is indicated on the oil container by the inscription
"MB-Freigabe" or "MB-Approval" and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB-Freigabe or
MB-Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines: in certain countries, different engine oils can be used, provided that the
maintenance intervals are reduced. For more
information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
407
408
Service products and capacities
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
When handling brake fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 402).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB-Freigabe or MBApproval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Technical data
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
a qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Service products and capacities
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 402).
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible
for the following:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
Rantifreeze protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
Mercedes-Benz recommends coolant or antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentrate in
accordance with
MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1
.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every maintenance interval at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Comply with the important safety notes for
service products when handling washer fluid
(Y page 402).
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
For the correct mixing ratio refer to the
information on the antifreeze reservoir.
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Z
Technical data
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
409
410
Vehicle data
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Model
:
Maximum
headroom
;
Opening
height
CLA 250
CLA 250
4MATIC
1814 mm
1979 mm
Mercedes-AMG
vehicles
1790 mm
1956 mm
All other models
1810 mm
1975 mm
Rthe
Technical data
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- Tyres
- Load
- Condition of the suspension
- Optional equipment
ROptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload
RVehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 402).
ROnly for certain countries: you can find
vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC
documents (Certificate of Conformity).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
CLA 250 Sport
4MATIC
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
Dimensions and weights
Vehicle length
Vehicle height
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
Wheel base
Maximum roof load
Maximum boot load
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Vehicle length
4691 mm
Vehicle height
1417 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2032 mm
Trailer tow hitch
411
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1777 mm
Wheel base
2699 mm
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Maximum boot load
100 kg
All other models
4630 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2032 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1777 mm
Wheel base
2699 mm
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Maximum boot load
100 kg
Model
Vehicle
height
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
1439 mm
All other models
1435 mm
: Anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
For trailer tow hitches fitted at the factory, the
overhang dimension including protective covering is 1121 mm.
Trailer tow hitch
Mounting dimensions
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle
type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis.
Z
Technical data
Vehicle length
412
Trailer tow hitch
Trailer loads
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 8%
from a standstill)
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200 d
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 180
CLA 180 d
CLA 250
1500 kg
Technical data
Automatic transmission
CLA 200 d
1500 kg
CLA 220 d
1500 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
1500 kg
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
1500 kg
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12%
from a standstill)
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
1200 kg
1200 kg
CLA 200
1400 kg
1400 kg
CLA 200 d
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 180
CLA 180 d
CLA 250
1500 kg
Trailer tow hitch
413
Automatic transmission
CLA 200 d
1500 kg
CLA 220 d
1500 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
1500 kg
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
1500 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
715 kg
730 kg
CLA 200
715 kg
730 kg
CLA 200 d
750 kg
750 kg
CLA 180
CLA 180 d
CLA 250
Technical data
750 kg
Automatic transmission
CLA 200 d
750 kg
CLA 220 d
750 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
750 kg
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
750 kg
Maximum drawbar noseweight
! Use a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum permissible noseweight.
Do not use a noseweight of less than 50kg, otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Note that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual payload.
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
The drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Z
414
Trailer tow hitch
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 200
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 200 d
75 kg
75 kg
CLA 180
CLA 180 d
CLA 250
75 kg
Automatic transmission
CLA 200 d
75 kg
CLA 220 d
75 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
75 kg
Technical data
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
75 kg
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
75 kg
The actual noseweight must not be higher than the value which is given. The value can be found
on the trailer tow hitch or trailer identification plates. The lowest weight applies.
You can attach carrier systems, e.g. bicycle racks or load-bearing implements, on the ball
coupling. The maximum noseweight of 75 kg applies when using carrier systems on the ball
coupling.
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
Towing a trailer is not possible with all models. For further information, see (Y page 239).
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
1030 kg
1030 kg
CLA 200
1030 kg
1030 kg
CLA 200 d
1035 kg
1030 kg
CLA 180
CLA 180 d
CLA 250
1040 kg
Trailer tow hitch
415
Automatic transmission
CLA 200 d
1080 kg
CLA 220 d
1030 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
1080 kg
CLA 250 Sport 4MATIC
1080 kg
Technical data
CLA 220 d 4MATIC
Z
416